1910012317 T1600G CLI
2018-01-11
: Tp-Link 1910012317 T1600G Cli 1910012317_T1600G_CLI 20180111 201801 2018
Open the PDF directly: View PDF .
Page Count: 473
Download | ![]() |
Open PDF In Browser | View PDF |
CLI Reference Guide T1600G-28TS / T1600G-28PS / T1600G-52TS (TL-SG2452) T1600G-52PS (TL-SG2452P) / T1600G-18TS (TL-SG2216) 1910012317 REV3.0.0 December 2017 COPYRIGHT & TRADEMARKS Specifications are subject to change without notice. is a registered trademark of TP-Link Technologies Co., Ltd. Other brands and product names are trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective holders. No part of the specifications may be reproduced in any form or by any means or used to make any derivative such as translation, transformation, or adaptation without permission from TP-Link Technologies Co., Ltd. Copyright © 2017 TP-Link Technologies Co., Ltd. All rights reserved. http://www.tp-link.com I CONTENTS Preface ............................................................................................................................ 1 Chapter 1 Using the CLI ................................................................................................... 5 1.1 Accessing the CLI ......................................................................................................................... 5 1.1.1 1.1.2 Logon by Telnet ........................................................................................................... 5 Logon by SSH ............................................................................................................... 6 1.2 CLI Command Modes ................................................................................................................. 11 1.3 Privilege Restrictions .................................................................................................................. 14 1.4 Conventions ................................................................................................................................. 14 1.4.1 Format Conventions .................................................................................................. 14 1.4.3 Parameter Format ...................................................................................................... 15 1.4.2 Chapter 2 Special Characters .................................................................................................... 15 User Interface ............................................................................................... 16 2.1 enable................................................................................................................................... 16 2.3 enable password ................................................................................................................ 17 2.2 2.4 2.5 2.6 2.7 2.8 2.9 2.10 Chapter 3 service password-encryption.......................................................................................... 16 enable secret ...................................................................................................................... 18 configure ............................................................................................................................. 19 exit ........................................................................................................................................ 20 end ........................................................................................................................................ 20 clipaging .............................................................................................................................. 21 history .................................................................................................................................. 21 history clear ........................................................................................................................ 22 User Management Commands ................................................................. 23 3.1 user name (password) ....................................................................................................... 23 3.3 show user account-list ...................................................................................................... 25 3.2 3.4 Chapter 4 user name (secret) ............................................................................................................. 24 show user configuration ................................................................................................... 26 System Configuration Commands .......................................................... 27 4.1 system-time manual .......................................................................................................... 27 4.3 system-time dst predefined............................................................................................. 29 4.2 4.4 4.5 system-time ntp ................................................................................................................. 27 system-time dst date ........................................................................................................ 30 system-time dst recurring ................................................................................................ 31 II 4.6 hostname............................................................................................................................. 32 4.8 contact-info ........................................................................................................................ 33 4.7 4.9 4.10 4.11 4.12 4.13 4.14 4.15 4.16 4.17 4.18 4.19 location ................................................................................................................................ 33 ip address ............................................................................................................................ 34 ip address-alloc .................................................................................................................. 35 reset ..................................................................................................................................... 36 reboot................................................................................................................................... 36 reboot-schedule ................................................................................................................ 37 copy running-config startup-config ............................................................................... 38 copy startup-config tftp ................................................................................................... 38 copy tftp startup-config ................................................................................................... 39 copy backup-config tftp ................................................................................................... 40 copy backup-config startup-config ............................................................................... 40 copy running-config backup-config............................................................................... 41 4.20 copy tftp backup-config ................................................................................................... 41 4.22 boot config .......................................................................................................................... 43 4.21 4.23 4.24 4.25 4.26 4.27 4.28 4.29 4.30 4.31 boot application ................................................................................................................. 42 remove backup-image ...................................................................................................... 43 firmware upgrade ............................................................................................................... 44 ping ....................................................................................................................................... 45 tracert .................................................................................................................................. 46 show system-info............................................................................................................... 47 show image-info ................................................................................................................. 47 show boot ............................................................................................................................ 48 show running-config ......................................................................................................... 48 show startup-config .......................................................................................................... 49 4.32 show system-time ............................................................................................................. 49 4.34 show system-time ntp....................................................................................................... 50 4.36 show cpu-utilization........................................................................................................... 51 4.33 4.35 4.37 Chapter 5 5.1 5.2 show system-time dst ....................................................................................................... 50 show cable-diagnostics interface................................................................................... 51 show memory-utilization .................................................................................................. 52 EEE Configuration Commands ................................................................. 53 eee ........................................................................................................................................ 53 show interface eee ............................................................................................................ 53 III Chapter 6 6.1 6.2 Chapter 7 SDM Template Commands ........................................................................ 55 sdm prefer ........................................................................................................................... 55 show sdm prefer ................................................................................................................ 56 Time Range Commands ............................................................................. 57 7.1 time-range ........................................................................................................................... 57 7.3 periodic ................................................................................................................................ 58 7.2 7.4 7.5 7.6 7.7 Chapter 8 absolute ............................................................................................................................... 57 holiday (time-range mode) ............................................................................................... 59 holiday .................................................................................................................................. 60 show holiday ....................................................................................................................... 60 show time-range ................................................................................................................ 61 Port Configuration Commands ................................................................ 62 8.1 interface gigabitEthernet.................................................................................................. 62 8.3 description .......................................................................................................................... 63 8.2 8.4 8.5 8.6 8.7 8.8 8.9 8.10 8.11 8.12 Chapter 9 9.1 9.2 interface range gigabitEthernet ...................................................................................... 62 shutdown ............................................................................................................................. 64 flow-control ......................................................................................................................... 65 duplex................................................................................................................................... 65 jumbo-size ........................................................................................................................... 66 speed ................................................................................................................................... 66 clear counters..................................................................................................................... 67 show interface status ........................................................................................................ 68 show interface counters ................................................................................................... 68 show interface configuration ........................................................................................... 69 Port Isolation Commands .......................................................................... 70 port isolation ....................................................................................................................... 70 show port isolation interface ........................................................................................... 71 Chapter 10 Loopback Detection Commands ............................................................. 72 10.1 10.2 10.3 10.4 loopback-detection (global) ............................................................................................. 72 loopback-detection interval ............................................................................................. 72 loopback-detection recovery-time ................................................................................ 73 loopback-detection (interface) ........................................................................................ 74 10.5 loopback-detection config process-mode ................................................................... 74 10.7 show loopback-detection global .................................................................................... 76 10.6 loopback-detection recover ............................................................................................ 75 IV 10.8 show loopback-detection interface ............................................................................... 76 Chapter 11 Etherchannel Commands .......................................................................... 78 11.1 channel-group .................................................................................................................... 78 11.3 lacp system-priority .......................................................................................................... 80 11.2 11.4 port-channel load-balance ............................................................................................... 79 lacp port-priority ................................................................................................................ 81 11.5 show etherchannel ............................................................................................................ 81 11.7 show lacp............................................................................................................................. 83 11.6 11.8 show etherchannel load-balance .................................................................................... 82 show lacp sys-id................................................................................................................. 83 Chapter 12 MAC Address Commands .......................................................................... 85 12.1 mac address-table static .................................................................................................. 85 12.2 mac address-table aging-time ........................................................................................ 86 12.4 mac address-table max-mac-count ............................................................................... 87 12.3 12.5 mac address-table filtering .............................................................................................. 86 show mac address-table .................................................................................................. 89 12.6 clear mac address-table ................................................................................................... 89 12.8 show mac address-table max-mac-count .................................................................... 90 12.7 show mac address-table aging-time .............................................................................. 90 12.9 show mac address-table interface ................................................................................. 91 12.11 show mac address-table address................................................................................... 92 12.10 12.12 show mac address-table count ....................................................................................... 91 show mac address-table vlan .......................................................................................... 93 Chapter 13 IEEE 802.1Q VLAN Commands ................................................................. 94 13.1 vlan ....................................................................................................................................... 94 13.2 name ..................................................................................................................................... 95 13.4 switchport pvid ................................................................................................................... 96 13.6 switchport acceptable frame ........................................................................................... 97 13.3 13.5 13.7 13.8 13.9 13.10 switchport general allowed vlan ...................................................................................... 95 switchport check ingress ................................................................................................. 97 show vlan summary ........................................................................................................... 98 show vlan brief.................................................................................................................... 99 show vlan ............................................................................................................................. 99 show interface switchport .............................................................................................. 100 V Chapter 14 MAC-based VLAN Commands ................................................................ 101 14.1 mac-vlan mac-address ................................................................................................... 101 14.2 mac-vlan ............................................................................................................................ 102 14.4 show mac-vlan interface ................................................................................................ 103 14.3 show mac-vlan.................................................................................................................. 102 Chapter 15 Protocol-based VLAN Commands ........................................................ 104 15.1 protocol-vlan template ................................................................................................... 104 15.2 protocol-vlan vlan ............................................................................................................ 105 15.4 show protocol-vlan template ......................................................................................... 106 15.3 15.5 protocol-vlan group......................................................................................................... 106 show protocol-vlan vlan.................................................................................................. 107 Chapter 16 GVRP Commands ....................................................................................... 108 16.1 gvrp..................................................................................................................................... 108 16.2 gvrp (interface) ................................................................................................................. 108 16.4 gvrp timer .......................................................................................................................... 110 16.3 16.5 16.6 gvrp registration............................................................................................................... 109 show gvrp interface ......................................................................................................... 111 show gvrp global .............................................................................................................. 112 Chapter 17 IGMP Snooping Commands..................................................................... 113 17.1 ip igmp snooping (global)................................................................................................ 113 17.2 ip igmp snooping version ............................................................................................... 113 17.4 ip igmp snooping header-validation ............................................................................. 115 17.6 ip igmp snooping vlan-config (immediate-leave) ....................................................... 117 17.3 17.5 17.7 17.8 ip igmp snooping drop-unknown .................................................................................. 114 ip igmp snooping vlan-config ........................................................................................ 115 ip igmp snooping vlan-config (report-suppression) .................................................. 117 ip igmp snooping vlan-config (router-ports-forbidden) ............................................ 118 17.9 ip igmp snooping vlan-config (rport interface) ........................................................... 119 17.11 ip igmp snooping vlan-config (querier) ........................................................................ 121 17.10 17.12 17.13 17.14 17.15 17.16 ip igmp snooping vlan-config (static) ........................................................................... 120 ip igmp snooping (interface) .......................................................................................... 122 ip igmp snooping max-groups ....................................................................................... 123 ip igmp snooping immediate-leave............................................................................... 124 ip igmp profile ................................................................................................................... 124 deny .................................................................................................................................... 125 VI 17.17 permit ................................................................................................................................. 125 17.19 ip igmp filter ...................................................................................................................... 127 17.18 17.20 17.21 17.22 17.23 17.24 17.25 range .................................................................................................................................. 126 clear ip igmp snooping statistics .................................................................................. 127 show ip igmp snooping ................................................................................................... 128 show ip igmp snooping interface .................................................................................. 128 show ip igmp snooping vlan ........................................................................................... 129 show ip igmp snooping groups ..................................................................................... 130 show ip igmp profile......................................................................................................... 131 Chapter 18 MLD Snooping Commands ...................................................................... 132 18.1 18.2 18.3 18.4 18.5 18.6 18.7 18.8 ipv6 mld snooping (global).............................................................................................. 132 ipv6 mld snooping drop-unknown ................................................................................ 132 ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config ...................................................................................... 133 ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (immediate-leave) ..................................................... 134 ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (report-suppression) ................................................ 135 ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (router-ports-forbidden) .......................................... 136 ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (rport interface) ......................................................... 137 ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (static) ......................................................................... 137 18.9 ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (querier) ...................................................................... 138 18.11 ipv6 mld snooping max-groups ..................................................................................... 140 18.10 ipv6 mld snooping (interface) ........................................................................................ 140 18.12 ipv6 mld snooping immediate-leave ............................................................................ 141 18.14 deny .................................................................................................................................... 143 18.13 18.15 18.16 18.17 ipv6 mld profile ................................................................................................................. 142 permit ................................................................................................................................. 143 range .................................................................................................................................. 144 ipv6 mld filter .................................................................................................................... 144 18.18 clear ipv6 mld snooping statistics ................................................................................ 145 18.20 show ipv6 mld snooping interface ................................................................................ 146 18.19 18.21 18.22 18.23 show ipv6 mld snooping ................................................................................................. 145 show ipv6 mld snooping vlan ......................................................................................... 147 show ipv6 mld snooping groups ................................................................................... 147 show ipv6 mld profile ...................................................................................................... 148 Chapter 19 MVR Commands ......................................................................................... 149 19.1 19.2 mvr (global) ........................................................................................................................ 149 mvr group .......................................................................................................................... 149 VII 19.3 mvr mode........................................................................................................................... 150 19.4 mvr querytime................................................................................................................... 151 19.6 mvr (interface)................................................................................................................... 152 19.5 19.7 19.8 mvr vlan.............................................................................................................................. 152 mvr type ............................................................................................................................. 153 mvr immediate .................................................................................................................. 154 19.9 mvr vlan (group) ................................................................................................................ 154 19.11 show mvr interface .......................................................................................................... 156 19.10 19.12 19.13 show mvr ........................................................................................................................... 155 show mvr members ......................................................................................................... 156 show mvr traffic................................................................................................................ 157 Chapter 20 MSTP Commands ....................................................................................... 158 20.1 20.2 20.3 20.4 20.5 debug spanning-tree ....................................................................................................... 158 spanning-tree (global) ..................................................................................................... 159 spanning-tree (interface) ................................................................................................ 159 spanning-tree common-config ..................................................................................... 160 spanning-tree mode ........................................................................................................ 161 20.6 spanning-tree mst configuration .................................................................................. 162 20.8 name ................................................................................................................................... 163 20.7 instance ............................................................................................................................. 162 20.9 revision .............................................................................................................................. 164 20.11 spanning-tree mst ........................................................................................................... 165 20.10 20.12 20.13 20.14 20.15 spanning-tree mst instance ........................................................................................... 165 spanning-tree priority ..................................................................................................... 166 spanning-tree timer ......................................................................................................... 167 spanning-tree hold-count .............................................................................................. 168 spanning-tree max-hops ................................................................................................ 168 20.16 spanning-tree bpdufilter ................................................................................................. 169 20.18 spanning-tree bpduguard .............................................................................................. 170 20.17 spanning-tree bpduflood................................................................................................ 170 20.19 spanning-tree guard loop ............................................................................................... 171 20.21 spanning-tree guard tc ................................................................................................... 172 20.20 spanning-tree guard root ............................................................................................... 172 20.22 spanning-tree mcheck .................................................................................................... 173 20.24 show spanning-tree bridge ............................................................................................ 174 20.23 20.25 show spanning-tree active ............................................................................................. 173 show spanning-tree interface........................................................................................ 174 VIII 20.26 20.27 show spanning-tree interface-security ....................................................................... 175 show spanning-tree mst ................................................................................................. 176 Chapter 21 LLDP Commands........................................................................................ 178 21.1 lldp ...................................................................................................................................... 178 21.3 lldp hold-multiplier ........................................................................................................... 179 21.2 21.4 lldp forward_message ..................................................................................................... 178 lldp timer ............................................................................................................................ 180 21.5 lldp receive ........................................................................................................................ 181 21.7 lldp snmp-trap .................................................................................................................. 182 21.6 21.8 lldp transmit ...................................................................................................................... 181 lldp tlv-select .................................................................................................................... 183 21.9 lldp management-address ............................................................................................. 183 21.11 lldp med-status ................................................................................................................ 185 21.10 21.12 21.13 21.14 21.15 21.16 21.17 21.18 lldp med-fast-count ......................................................................................................... 184 lldp med-tlv-select ........................................................................................................... 185 lldp med-location ............................................................................................................. 186 show lldp ............................................................................................................................ 187 show lldp interface........................................................................................................... 187 show lldp local-information interface ........................................................................... 188 show lldp neighbor-information interface ................................................................... 189 show lldp traffic interface ............................................................................................... 189 Chapter 22 Static Routes Commands ........................................................................ 191 22.1 22.2 22.3 22.4 22.5 22.6 22.7 22.8 22.9 ip routing............................................................................................................................ 191 interface vlan .................................................................................................................... 191 interface loopback ........................................................................................................... 192 switchport ......................................................................................................................... 192 interface range port-channel ......................................................................................... 193 description ........................................................................................................................ 194 shutdown ........................................................................................................................... 194 interface port-channel .................................................................................................... 195 ip route ............................................................................................................................... 196 22.10 ipv6 routing ....................................................................................................................... 196 22.12 show interface vlan .......................................................................................................... 198 22.11 22.13 22.14 ipv6 route .......................................................................................................................... 197 show ip interface .............................................................................................................. 198 show ip interface brief..................................................................................................... 199 IX 22.15 show ip route .................................................................................................................... 199 22.16 show ip route specify ...................................................................................................... 200 22.18 show ipv6 interface ......................................................................................................... 201 22.17 22.19 22.20 show ip route summary................................................................................................... 201 show ipv6 route ................................................................................................................ 202 show ipv6 route summary .............................................................................................. 202 Chapter 23 IPv6 Address Configuration Commands ............................................. 204 23.1 ipv6 enable ........................................................................................................................ 204 23.2 ipv6 address autoconfig ................................................................................................. 204 23.4 ipv6 address dhcp ........................................................................................................... 206 23.6 ipv6 address eui-64 ......................................................................................................... 207 23.3 23.5 23.7 23.8 ipv6 address link-local .................................................................................................... 205 ipv6 address ra ................................................................................................................. 206 ipv6 address ..................................................................................................................... 208 show ipv6 interface ......................................................................................................... 209 Chapter 24 ARP Commands .......................................................................................... 210 24.1 arp ....................................................................................................................................... 210 24.3 arp dynamicrenew ........................................................................................................... 211 24.2 24.4 24.5 24.6 24.7 24.8 clear arp-cache ................................................................................................................ 211 arp timeout ........................................................................................................................ 212 gratuitous-arp intf-status-up enable ............................................................................ 212 gratuitous-arp dup-ip-detected enable ....................................................................... 213 gratuitous-arp learning enable ...................................................................................... 213 gratuitous-arp send-interval .......................................................................................... 214 24.9 ip proxy-arp ....................................................................................................................... 215 24.11 show arp ............................................................................................................................ 216 24.10 24.12 24.13 24.14 24.15 ip local-proxy-arp ............................................................................................................. 215 show ip arp (interface) ..................................................................................................... 217 show ip arp summary ...................................................................................................... 217 show gratuitous-arp ........................................................................................................ 218 show ip proxy-arp ............................................................................................................ 218 Chapter 25 DHCP Server Commands ......................................................................... 220 25.1 25.2 25.3 25.4 service dhcp server ......................................................................................................... 220 ip dhcp server extend-option capwap-ac-ip .............................................................. 220 ip dhcp server extend-option vendor-class-id ........................................................... 221 ip dhcp server exclude-address ................................................................................... 222 X 25.5 ip dhcp server pool .......................................................................................................... 222 25.7 ip dhcp server ping packets ........................................................................................... 224 25.6 25.8 25.9 ip dhcp server ping timeout ........................................................................................... 223 network .............................................................................................................................. 224 lease ................................................................................................................................... 225 25.10 address hardware-address ............................................................................................ 226 25.12 default-gateway ............................................................................................................... 227 25.11 25.13 25.14 25.15 address client-identifier.................................................................................................. 226 dns-server ......................................................................................................................... 228 netbios-name-server ...................................................................................................... 229 netbios-node-type........................................................................................................... 229 25.16 next-server ........................................................................................................................ 230 25.18 bootfile ............................................................................................................................... 231 25.20 show ip dhcp server statistics ....................................................................................... 232 25.17 25.19 25.21 domain-name.................................................................................................................... 231 show ip dhcp server status ............................................................................................ 232 show ip dhcp server extend-option.............................................................................. 233 25.22 show ip dhcp server pool ............................................................................................... 233 25.24 show ip dhcp server manual-binding ........................................................................... 234 25.26 clear ip dhcp server statistics........................................................................................ 235 25.23 25.25 25.27 show ip dhcp server excluded-address....................................................................... 234 show ip dhcp server binding .......................................................................................... 235 clear ip dhcp server binding ........................................................................................... 236 Chapter 26 DHCP Relay Commands ........................................................................... 237 26.1 26.2 service dhcp relay ............................................................................................................ 237 ip dhcp relay hops ............................................................................................................ 237 26.3 ip dhcp relay time ............................................................................................................. 238 26.5 ip dhcp relay information ................................................................................................ 239 26.7 ip dhcp relay information format ................................................................................... 241 26.4 26.6 26.8 ip helper-address ............................................................................................................. 239 ip dhcp relay information strategy ................................................................................ 240 ip dhcp relay information circuit-id ............................................................................... 242 26.9 ip dhcp relay information remote-id ............................................................................. 242 26.11 ip dhcp relay vlan ............................................................................................................. 244 26.10 26.12 ip dhcp relay default-interface ...................................................................................... 243 show ip dhcp relay ........................................................................................................... 244 XI Chapter 27 DHCP L2 Relay Commands ..................................................................... 246 27.1 27.2 27.3 27.4 27.5 27.6 ip dhcp l2relay .................................................................................................................. 246 ip dhcp l2relay vlan .......................................................................................................... 246 ip dhcp l2relay information ............................................................................................. 247 ip dhcp l2relay information strategy............................................................................. 247 ip dhcp l2relay information format ................................................................................ 248 ip dhcp l2relay information circuit-id............................................................................ 249 27.7 ip dhcp l2relay information remote-id .......................................................................... 250 27.9 show ip dhcp l2relay interface ....................................................................................... 251 27.8 show ip dhcp l2relay ........................................................................................................ 250 Chapter 28 QoS Commands.......................................................................................... 252 28.1 qos trust mode ................................................................................................................. 252 28.2 qos port-priority ............................................................................................................... 253 28.4 qos dot1p-remap ............................................................................................................. 254 28.3 qos cos-map ..................................................................................................................... 253 28.5 qos dscp-map................................................................................................................... 255 28.7 qos queue mode .............................................................................................................. 256 28.9 show qos dot1p-remap .................................................................................................. 258 28.6 28.8 qos dscp-remap ............................................................................................................... 256 show qos cos-map .......................................................................................................... 257 28.10 show qos dscp-map ........................................................................................................ 258 28.12 show qos port-priority interface ................................................................................... 259 28.11 28.13 28.14 show qos dscp-remap .................................................................................................... 259 show qos trust interface ................................................................................................. 260 show qos queue interface .............................................................................................. 260 Chapter 29 Bandwidth Control Commands .............................................................. 262 29.1 29.2 29.3 29.4 29.5 29.6 29.7 storm-control rate-mode ............................................................................................... 262 storm-control.................................................................................................................... 262 storm-control exceed ..................................................................................................... 263 storm-control recover .................................................................................................... 264 bandwidth .......................................................................................................................... 265 show storm-control ......................................................................................................... 266 show bandwidth ............................................................................................................... 266 Chapter 30 Voice VLAN Commands ........................................................................... 268 30.1 voice vlan ........................................................................................................................... 268 XII 30.2 voice vlan (interface) ....................................................................................................... 268 30.4 voice vlan oui .................................................................................................................... 270 30.3 voice vlan priority ............................................................................................................. 269 30.5 show voice vlan ................................................................................................................ 270 30.7 show voice vlan interface ............................................................................................... 271 30.6 show voice vlan oui-table ............................................................................................... 271 Chapter 31 Auto VoIP Commands ............................................................................... 273 31.1 31.2 31.3 31.4 31.5 auto-voip ........................................................................................................................... 273 auto-voip (interface) ........................................................................................................ 273 auto-voip dot1p................................................................................................................ 274 auto-voip untagged ......................................................................................................... 275 auto-voip none ................................................................................................................. 275 31.6 no auto-voip (interface)................................................................................................... 276 31.8 auto-voip data priority..................................................................................................... 277 31.7 31.9 auto-voip dscp ................................................................................................................. 276 show auto-voip ................................................................................................................. 277 Chapter 32 Access Control Commands .................................................................... 279 32.1 32.2 32.3 32.4 32.5 32.6 user access-control ip-based enable .......................................................................... 279 user access-control ip-based ....................................................................................... 279 user access-control mac-based enable ...................................................................... 280 user access-control mac-based ................................................................................... 281 user access-control port-based enable ...................................................................... 282 user access-control port-based ................................................................................... 282 Chapter 33 HTTP and HTTPS Commands ................................................................. 284 33.1 33.2 33.3 33.4 33.5 33.6 33.7 33.8 33.9 ip http server ..................................................................................................................... 284 ip http port ......................................................................................................................... 284 ip http max-users ............................................................................................................. 285 ip http session timeout ................................................................................................... 286 ip http secure-server ....................................................................................................... 287 ip http secure-port........................................................................................................... 287 ip http secure-protocol ................................................................................................... 288 ip http secure-ciphersuite .............................................................................................. 289 ip http secure-max-users ............................................................................................... 289 33.10 ip http secure-session timeout ..................................................................................... 290 33.12 ip http secure-server download key ............................................................................. 292 33.11 ip http secure-server download certificate ................................................................. 291 XIII 33.13 33.14 show ip http configuration.............................................................................................. 293 show ip http secure-server ............................................................................................ 293 Chapter 34 SSH Commands .......................................................................................... 295 34.1 ip ssh server ...................................................................................................................... 295 34.2 ip ssh port .......................................................................................................................... 295 34.4 ip ssh algorithm ................................................................................................................ 297 34.3 ip ssh version .................................................................................................................... 296 34.5 ip ssh timeout ................................................................................................................... 297 34.7 ip ssh download................................................................................................................ 299 34.6 34.8 34.9 ip ssh max-client .............................................................................................................. 298 remove public-key ........................................................................................................... 299 show ip ssh ........................................................................................................................ 300 Chapter 35 Telnet Commands...................................................................................... 301 35.1 35.2 35.3 telnet enable ..................................................................................................................... 301 telnet port .......................................................................................................................... 301 show telnet-status ........................................................................................................... 302 Chapter 36 AAA Commands ......................................................................................... 303 36.1 36.2 36.3 36.4 36.5 36.6 36.7 36.8 36.9 tacacas-server host ........................................................................................................ 303 show tacacs-server ......................................................................................................... 304 radius-server host ........................................................................................................... 305 show radius-server .......................................................................................................... 306 aaa group........................................................................................................................... 307 server ................................................................................................................................. 308 show aaa group ................................................................................................................ 308 aaa authentication login.................................................................................................. 309 aaa authentication enable .............................................................................................. 310 36.10 aaa authentication dot1x default................................................................................... 311 36.12 show aaa authentication ................................................................................................. 312 36.11 36.13 36.14 36.15 36.16 36.17 36.18 36.19 aaa accounting dot1x default ........................................................................................ 312 show aaa accounting....................................................................................................... 313 line telnet ........................................................................................................................... 313 login authentication (telnet)............................................................................................ 314 line ssh ............................................................................................................................... 315 login authentication (ssh)................................................................................................ 315 enable authentication (telnet) ........................................................................................ 316 enable authentication (ssh) ............................................................................................ 317 XIV 36.20 ip http login authentication............................................................................................. 317 36.21 ip http enable authentication ......................................................................................... 318 36.23 enable-admin .................................................................................................................... 319 36.22 show aaa global ................................................................................................................ 319 Chapter 37 IEEE 802.1x Commands ............................................................................ 321 37.1 37.2 dot1x system-auth-control ............................................................................................ 321 dot1x handshake.............................................................................................................. 322 37.3 dot1x auth-protocol ........................................................................................................ 322 37.5 dot1x accounting ............................................................................................................. 324 37.4 dot1x vlan-assignment ................................................................................................... 323 37.6 dot1x mab ......................................................................................................................... 325 37.8 dot1x timeout quiet-period ............................................................................................ 326 37.10 dot1x max- req ................................................................................................................. 328 37.7 37.9 dot1x guest-vlan .............................................................................................................. 325 dot1x timeout supp-timeout .......................................................................................... 327 37.11 dot1x .................................................................................................................................. 328 37.13 dot1x port-method .......................................................................................................... 330 37.12 37.14 37.15 37.16 37.17 37.18 dot1x port-control ........................................................................................................... 329 dot1x auth-init .................................................................................................................. 331 dot1x auth-reauth ............................................................................................................ 331 show dot1x global ............................................................................................................ 332 show dot1x interface....................................................................................................... 333 show dot1x auth-state .................................................................................................... 333 Chapter 38 Port Security Commands......................................................................... 335 38.1 38.2 mac address-table max-mac count.............................................................................. 335 show mac address-table max-mac-count .................................................................. 335 Chapter 39 Port Mirroring Commands ....................................................................... 337 39.1 monitor session destination interface ......................................................................... 337 39.3 show monitor session ..................................................................................................... 339 39.2 monitor session source .................................................................................................. 338 Chapter 40 ACL Commands .......................................................................................... 341 40.1 access-list create ............................................................................................................ 341 40.2 access-list resequence .................................................................................................. 341 40.4 access-list ip ..................................................................................................................... 343 40.3 access-list mac ................................................................................................................ 342 XV 40.5 40.6 40.7 40.8 access-list ipv6 ................................................................................................................ 345 access-list action ............................................................................................................. 347 redirect interface ............................................................................................................. 348 s-condition ........................................................................................................................ 348 40.9 s-mirror .............................................................................................................................. 349 40.11 access bind ....................................................................................................................... 351 40.13 show access-list bind...................................................................................................... 352 40.10 40.12 40.14 40.15 40.16 qos-remark........................................................................................................................ 350 show access-list .............................................................................................................. 352 show access-list status .................................................................................................. 353 show access-list counter ............................................................................................... 353 clear access-list ............................................................................................................... 354 Chapter 41 IPv4 IMPB Commands ............................................................................... 355 41.1 41.2 41.3 ip source binding.............................................................................................................. 355 ip dhcp snooping ............................................................................................................. 356 ip dhcp snooping vlan ..................................................................................................... 357 41.4 ip dhcp snooping max-entries ....................................................................................... 357 41.6 show ip dhcp snooping ................................................................................................... 359 41.5 41.7 show ip source binding ................................................................................................... 358 show ip dhcp snooping interface .................................................................................. 359 Chapter 42 IPv6 IMPB Commands ............................................................................... 361 42.1 42.2 42.3 Ipv6 source binding ......................................................................................................... 361 ipv6 dhcp snooping ......................................................................................................... 362 ipv6 dhcp snooping vlan ................................................................................................. 363 42.4 ipv6 dhcp snooping max-entries .................................................................................. 363 42.6 ipv6 nd snooping vlan ..................................................................................................... 365 42.8 show ipv6 source binding............................................................................................... 366 42.5 42.7 ipv6 nd snooping.............................................................................................................. 364 ipv6 nd snooping max-entries ....................................................................................... 365 42.9 show ipv6 dhcp snooping............................................................................................... 367 42.11 show ipv6 nd snooping ................................................................................................... 368 42.10 show ipv6 dhcp snooping interface ............................................................................. 367 Chapter 43 IP Verify Source Commands ................................................................... 369 43.1 43.2 43.3 ip verify source ................................................................................................................. 369 ip verify source logging................................................................................................... 370 show ip verify source ...................................................................................................... 370 XVI 43.4 show ip verify source interface ..................................................................................... 371 Chapter 44 IPv6 Verify Source Commands .............................................................. 372 44.1 44.2 44.3 ipv6 verify source............................................................................................................. 372 show ipv6 verify source .................................................................................................. 373 show ipv6 verify source interface ................................................................................. 373 Chapter 45 DHCPv4 Filter Commands ....................................................................... 375 45.1 45.2 45.3 45.4 45.5 45.6 45.7 45.8 45.9 ip dhcp filter ...................................................................................................................... 375 ip dhcp filter (interface) ................................................................................................... 375 ip dhcp filter mac-verify .................................................................................................. 376 ip dhcp filter limit rate ...................................................................................................... 377 ip dhcp filter decline rate ................................................................................................ 378 ip dhcp filter server permit-entry .................................................................................. 378 show ip dhcp filter ............................................................................................................ 379 show ip dhcp filter interface ........................................................................................... 380 show ip dhcp filter server permit-entry........................................................................ 380 Chapter 46 DHCPv6 Filter Commands ....................................................................... 382 46.1 46.2 ipv6 dhcp filter .................................................................................................................. 382 ipv6 dhcp filter (interface)............................................................................................... 382 46.3 ipv6 dhcp filter limit rate ................................................................................................. 383 46.5 ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry .............................................................................. 385 46.4 ipv6 dhcp filter decline rate............................................................................................ 384 46.6 show ipv6 dhcp filter ....................................................................................................... 386 46.8 show ip dhcp filter server permit-entry........................................................................ 387 46.7 show ipv6 dhcp filter interface ...................................................................................... 386 Chapter 47 DoS Defend Commands ........................................................................... 388 47.1 47.2 47.3 ip dos-prevent .................................................................................................................. 388 ip dos-prevent type ......................................................................................................... 388 show ip dos-prevent........................................................................................................ 390 Chapter 48 DLDP Commands ....................................................................................... 392 48.1 48.2 48.3 48.4 48.5 dldp (global) ....................................................................................................................... 392 dldp interval....................................................................................................................... 392 dldp shut-mode ................................................................................................................ 393 dldp(interface) .................................................................................................................. 394 show dldp .......................................................................................................................... 394 XVII 48.6 show dldp interface ......................................................................................................... 395 Chapter 49 SNMP Commands ...................................................................................... 396 49.1 49.2 49.3 49.4 49.5 49.6 snmp-server...................................................................................................................... 396 snmp-server view ............................................................................................................ 396 snmp-server group .......................................................................................................... 397 snmp-server user............................................................................................................. 399 snmp-server community ................................................................................................ 400 snmp-server host............................................................................................................. 401 49.7 snmp-server engineID .................................................................................................... 403 49.9 snmp-server traps ........................................................................................................... 404 49.8 49.10 49.11 49.12 49.13 49.14 49.15 49.16 snmp-server traps snmp ................................................................................................ 403 snmp-server traps ddm .................................................................................................. 406 snmp-server traps vlan ................................................................................................... 407 snmp-server traps security ............................................................................................ 408 snmp-server traps acl ..................................................................................................... 409 snmp-server traps ip ....................................................................................................... 409 snmp-server traps power ............................................................................................... 410 snmp-server traps link-status ....................................................................................... 411 49.17 rmon history ...................................................................................................................... 412 49.19 rmon alarm ........................................................................................................................ 414 49.18 49.20 49.21 rmon event ........................................................................................................................ 413 rmon statistics .................................................................................................................. 415 show snmp-server ........................................................................................................... 416 49.22 show snmp-server view .................................................................................................. 416 49.24 show snmp-server user .................................................................................................. 417 49.26 show snmp-server host .................................................................................................. 418 49.28 show rmon history ........................................................................................................... 419 49.23 49.25 49.27 show snmp-server group ............................................................................................... 417 show snmp-server community ...................................................................................... 418 show snmp-server engineID .......................................................................................... 419 49.29 show rmon event.............................................................................................................. 420 49.31 show rmon statistics ....................................................................................................... 421 49.30 show rmon alarm .............................................................................................................. 420 Chapter 50 PoE Commands .......................................................................................... 422 50.1 50.2 power inline consumption (global) ................................................................................ 422 power profile ..................................................................................................................... 422 XVIII 50.3 power inline consumption (interface) ........................................................................... 423 50.4 power inline priority ......................................................................................................... 424 50.6 power inline profile........................................................................................................... 425 50.5 50.7 50.8 50.9 50.10 50.11 power inline supply .......................................................................................................... 425 power inline time-range .................................................................................................. 426 show power inline ............................................................................................................ 427 show power inline configuration interface .................................................................. 427 show power inline information interface...................................................................... 428 show power profile .......................................................................................................... 428 Chapter 51 ARP Inspection Commands ..................................................................... 429 51.1 51.2 ip arp inspection ............................................................................................................... 429 ip arp inspection validate ................................................................................................ 429 51.3 ip arp inspection vlan ...................................................................................................... 430 51.5 ip arp inspection trust ..................................................................................................... 432 51.7 ip arp inspection burst-interval ..................................................................................... 433 51.4 51.6 51.8 51.9 ip arp inspection vlan logging ........................................................................................ 431 ip arp inspection limit-rate.............................................................................................. 432 ip arp inspection recover ................................................................................................ 434 show ip arp inspection .................................................................................................... 434 51.10 show ip arp inspection interface ................................................................................... 435 51.12 show ip arp inspection statistics ................................................................................... 436 51.11 51.13 show ip arp inspection vlan ............................................................................................ 436 clear ip arp inspection statistics ................................................................................... 437 Chapter 52 ND Detection Commands ........................................................................ 438 52.1 ipv6 nd detection ............................................................................................................. 438 52.2 ipv6 nd detection vlan ..................................................................................................... 438 52.4 ipv6 nd detection trust .................................................................................................... 439 52.6 show ipv6 nd detection interface.................................................................................. 440 52.3 52.5 52.7 ipv6 nd detection vlan logging....................................................................................... 439 show ipv6 nd detection ................................................................................................... 440 show ipv6 nd detection vlan .......................................................................................... 441 Chapter 53 System Log Commands ........................................................................... 442 53.1 53.2 53.3 53.4 logging buffer ................................................................................................................... 442 logging buffer level .......................................................................................................... 442 logging file flash ............................................................................................................... 443 logging file flash frequency ............................................................................................ 444 XIX 53.5 logging file flash level ...................................................................................................... 445 53.6 logging host index............................................................................................................ 445 53.8 logging console level....................................................................................................... 447 53.7 logging console ................................................................................................................ 446 53.9 logging monitor ................................................................................................................ 448 53.11 clear logging ..................................................................................................................... 449 53.10 53.12 logging monitor level ....................................................................................................... 448 show logging local-config .............................................................................................. 450 53.13 show logging loghost ...................................................................................................... 450 53.15 show logging flash ........................................................................................................... 451 53.14 show logging buffer ......................................................................................................... 451 XX Preface This Guide is intended for network administrator to provide referenced information about CLI (Command Line Interface). The device mentioned in this Guide stands for T1600G-28TS/ T1600G-52TS/ T1600G-28MPS/T1600G-18TS JetStream Gigabit L2 Managed Switch without any explanation. The commands in this guide apply to these models if not specially noted, and T1600G-28TS is taken as an example model in the example commands. Some models featured in this guide may be unavailable in your country or region. For local sales information, visit http://www.tp-link.com. Overview of this Guide Chapter 1: Using the CLI Provide information about how to use the CLI, CLI Command Modes, Security Levels and some Conventions. Chapter 2: User Interface Provide information about the commands used to switch between five CLI Command Modes. Chapter 3: User Management Commands Provide information about the commands used for user management. Chapter 4: System Configuration Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the System information and System IP, reboot and reset the switch, upgrade the switch system and commands used for cable test. Chapter 5: EEE Configuration Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring EEE. Chapter 6: SDM Template Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the SDM templates. Chapter 7: Time Range Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the time range. Chapter 8: Port Configuration Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the Speed, Negotiation Mode, and Flow Control for Ethernet ports. Chapter 9: Port Isolation Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring Port Isolation function. Chapter 10: Loopback Detection Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the Loopback Detection function. 1 Chapter 11: Etherchannel Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring LAG (Link Aggregation Group) and LACP (Link Aggregation Control Protocol). Chapter 12: MAC Address Commands Provide information about the commands used for Address configuration. Chapter 13: IEEE 802.1Q VLAN Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring IEEE 802.1Q VLAN. Chapter 14: MAC-based VLAN Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring MAC-based VLAN. Chapter 15: Protocol-based VLAN Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring Protocol VLAN. Chapter 16: GVRP Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring GVRP (GARP VLAN registration protocol). Chapter 17: IGMP Snooping Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the IGMP Snooping (Internet Group Management Protocol Snooping). Chapter 18: MLD Snooping Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the MLD Snooping (Multicast Listener Discovery Snooping). Chapter 19: MVR Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the MVR. Chapter 20: MSTP Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the MSTP (Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol). Chapter 21: LLDP Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring LLDP function. Chapter 22: Static Routes Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the Static Route function. Chapter 23: IPv6 Address Configuration Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the System IPv6 addresses. Chapter 24: ARP Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the ARP (Address Resolution Protocol) functions. 2 Chapter 25: DHCP Server Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the DHCP Server function. Chapter 26: DHCP Relay Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the DHCP Relay function. Chapter 27: DHCP L2 Relay Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the DHCP L2 Relay function. Chapter 28: QoS Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the QoS function. Chapter 29: Bandwidth Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the Bandwidth Control. Chapter 30: Voice VLAN Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring Voice VLAN. Chapter 31 Auto VoIP Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring Auto VoIP. Chapter 32: Access Control Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring Access Control. Chapter 33: HTTP and HTTPS Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the HTTP and HTTPS logon. Chapter 34: SSH Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring and managing SSH (Security Shell). Chapter 35: Telnet Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring and managing SSH (Security Shell). Chapter 36: AAA Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring AAA (authentication, authorization and accounting). Chapter 37: IEEE 802.1X Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring IEEE 802.1X function. Chapter 38 Port Security Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring Port Security. Chapter 39: Port Mirroring Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the Port Mirror function. 3 Chapter 40: ACL Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the ACL (Access Control List). Chapter 41: IPv4 IMPB Commands Provide information about the commands used for binding the IP address, MAC address, VLAN and the connected Port number of the Host together. Chapter 42: IPv6 IMPB Commands Provide information about the commands used for binding the IPv6 address, MAC address, VLAN and the connected Port number of the Host together. Chapter 43: IP Verify Source Commands Provide information about the commands used for guarding the IP Source by filtering the IP packets based on the IP-MAC Binding entries. Chapter 44: IPv6 Verify Source Commands Provide information about the commands used for guarding the IPv6 Source by filtering the IP packets based on the IP-MAC Binding entries. Chapter 45: DHCPv4 Filter Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the DHCPv4 Filter. Chapter 46: DHCPv6 Filter Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the DHCPv6 Filter. Chapter 47: DoS Defend Command Provide information about the commands used for DoS defend and detecting the DoS attack. Chapter 48: DLDP Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the DLDP (Device Link Detection Protocol). Chapter 49: SNMP Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring the SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) functions. Chapter 50: PoE Commands (For T1600G-28MPS only) Provide information about the commands used for configuring PoE function. Chapter 51: ARP Inspection Commands Provide information about the commands used for protecting the switch from the ARP cheating or ARP Attack. Chapter 52: ND Detection Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring ND detection. Chapter 53: System Log Commands Provide information about the commands used for configuring system log. 4 Chapter 1 Using the CLI 1.1 Accessing the CLI You can log on to the switch and access the CLI by logging on to the switch remotely by a Telnet or SSH connection through an Ethernet port. 1.1.1 Logon by Telnet To log on to the switch by a Telnet connection, please take the following steps: 1. Click Start and type in cmd in the Search programs and files window and press the Enter button. Figure 1-1 Run Window 2. Type in telnet 192.168.0.1 in the cmd window and press Enter. Figure 1-2 Type in the telnet command 5 3. Type in the login username and password (both admin by default). Press Enter and you will enter User EXEC Mode. Figure 1-2 Log in the Switch 4. Type in enable command and you will enter Privileged EXEC Mode. By default no password is needed. Later you can set a password for users who want to access the Privileged EXEC Mode. Figure 1-3 Enter into Priviledged EXEC Mode 1.1.2 Logon by SSH To log on by SSH, a Putty client software is recommended. There are two authentication modes to set up an SSH connection: Password Authentication Mode: It requires username and password, which are both admin by default. Key Authentication Mode: It requires a public key for the switch and a private key for the SSH client software. You can generate the public key and the private key through Putty Key Generator. Note: Before SSH login, please follow the steps shown in Figure 1-4 to enable the SSH function through Telnet connection. 6 Figure 1-4 Enable SSH function Password Authentication Mode 1. Open the software to log on to the interface of PuTTY. Enter the IP address of the switch into Host Name field; keep the default value 22 in the Port field; select SSH as the Connection type. Figure 1-5 SSH Connection Config 7 2. Click the Open button in the above figure to log on to the switch. Enter the login user name and password to log on the switch, and then enter enable to enter Privileged EXEC Mode, so you can continue to configure the switch. Figure 1-6 Log on the Switch Key Authentication Mode 1. Select the key type and key length, and generate SSH key. Figure 1-7 Generate SSH Key 1. 2. Note: The key length is in the range of 512 to 3072 bits. During the key generation, randomly moving the mouse quickly can accelerate the key generation. 8 2. After the key is successfully generated, please save the public key and private key to a TFTP server. Figure 1-8 Save the Generated Key 3. Log on to the switch by Telnet and download the public key file from the TFTP server to the switch, as the following figure shows: Figure 1-9 Download the Public Key 9 Note: 1. The key type should accord with the type of the key file. 4. After the public key is downloaded, please log on to the interface of PuTTY and enter the IP 2. The SSH key downloading can not be interrupted. address for login. Figure 1-10 SSH Connection Config 10 5. Click Browse to download the private key file to SSH client software and click Open. Figure 1-11 Download the Private Key 6. After successful authentication, please enter the login user name. If you log on to the switch without entering password, it indicates that the key has been successfully downloaded. Figure 1-12 Log on the Switch 1.2 CLI Command Modes The CLI is divided into different command modes: User EXEC Mode, Privileged EXEC Mode, Global Configuration Mode, Interface Configuration Mode and VLAN Configuration Mode. 11 Interface Configuration Mode can also be divided into Interface Ethernet, Interface link-aggregation and some other modes, which is shown as the following diagram. The following table gives detailed information about the Accessing path, Prompt of each mode and how to exit the current mode and access the next mode. Mode Accessing Path User EXEC Primary mode once Mode Privileged EXEC Mode it is connected with Prompt T1600G-52TS> disconnect the switch. Use the enable command to access Privileged EXEC mode. Enter the disable or the exit command to return to User Use the enable this mode from User mode Use the exit command to the switch. command to enter Logout or Access the next T1600G-52TS# EXEC mode. EXEC mode. Enter configure command to access Global Configuration mode. Use the exit or the end command or press Ctrl+Z to return to Privileged EXEC mode. Global Configuration Mode Use the configure command to enter this mode from Use the interface T1600G-52TS(config)# gigabitEthernet port or interface range gigabitEthernet port-list Privileged EXEC command to access interface mode. Configuration mode. Use the vlan vlan-list to access VLAN Configuration mode. Layer 2 Interface: Use the interface gigabitEthernet Interface Configuration Mode port, interface port-channel T1600G-52TS (config-if)# port-channel-id or interface range gigabitEthernet port-list command to or T1600G-52TS(config-if-range)# Use the end command or press Ctrl+Z to return to Privileged EXEC mode. Enter the exit or the # command to return to Global Configuration mode. A port number must be specified in the interface command. enter this mode from Global Configuration mode. 12 Mode Accessing Path Prompt Logout or Access the next mode Layer 3 Interface: Use the no switchport command to enter Routed Port mode from Interface Configuration mode. Interface Configuration Mode Use the interface vlan vlan-id command to enter VLAN Interface mode from Global Configuration mode. T1600G-52TS (config-if)# or T1600G-52TS(config-if-range)# Use the switchport command to switch to the Layer 2 interface mode. Use the end command or press Ctrl+Z to return to Privileged EXEC mode. Enter the exit or the # command to return to Global Configuration mode. Use the interface loopback id command to enter Loopback Interface mode from Global Configuration mode. VLAN Configuration Mode 1. 2. Use the end command or press Use the vlan vlan-list command to enter this mode from Ctrl+Z to return to Privileged T1600G-52TS (config-vlan)# Global Configuration EXEC mode. Enter the exit command or the # command to return to Global mode. configuration mode. Note: The user is automatically in User EXEC Mode after the connection between the PC and the switch is established by a Telnet/SSH connection. Each command mode has its own set of specific commands. To configure some commands, you should access the corresponding command mode firstly. Global Configuration Mode: In this mode, global commands are provided, such as the Spanning Tree, Schedule Mode and so on. Interface Configuration Mode: In this mode, users can configure one or several ports, different ports corresponds to different commands a). Interface gigabitEthernet: Configure parameters for an Ethernet port, such as Duplex-mode, flow control status. b). Interface range gigabitEthernet: Configure parameters for several Ethernet ports. 13 c). Interface link-aggregation: Configure parameters for a link-aggregation, such as broadcast storm. d). Interface range link-aggregation: Configure parameters for multi-trunks. e). Interface vlan: Configure parameters for the vlan-port. VLAN Configuration Mode: In this mode, users can create a VLAN and add a specified port to the VLAN. 3. Some commands are global, that means they can be performed in all modes: show: Display all information of switch, for example: statistic information, port information, VLAN information. history: Display the commands history.. 1.3 Privilege Restrictions This switch’s security is divided into four privilege levels: User level, Power User level, Operator level and Admin level. You can define username and password pairs, and assign a specific privilege level to each pair. Different privilege levels have access to specified commands, which is illustrated in the Privilege Requirement in each command. For details about how to configure usename and password pairs, please refer to user name (password) and user name (secret). Users can enter Privileged EXEC mode from User EXEC mode by using the enable command. In default case, no password is needed. In Global Configuration Mode, you can configure password for Admin level by enable password command. Once password is configured, you are required to enter it to access Privileged EXEC mode. 1.4 Conventions 1.4.1 Format Conventions The following conventions are used in this Guide: Items in square brackets [ ] are optional Items in braces { } are required Alternative items are grouped in braces and separated by vertical bars. For example: speed {10 | 100 | 1000 } Bold indicates an unalterable keyword. For example: show logging 14 Normal Font indicates a constant (several options are enumerated and only one can be selected). For example: mode {dynamic | static | permanent} Italic Font indicates a variable (an actual value must be assigned). For example: bridge aging-time aging-time 1.4.2 Special Characters You should pay attentions to the description below if the variable is a character string: These six characters ” < > , \ & cannot be input. If a blank is contained in a character string, single or double quotation marks should be used, for example ’hello world’, ”hello world”, and the words in the quotation marks will be identified as a string. Otherwise, the words will be identified as several strings. 1.4.3 Parameter Format Some parameters must be entered in special formats which are shown as follows: MAC address must be enter in the format of xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx. One or several values can be typed for a port-list or a vlan-list using comma to separate. Use a hyphen to designate a range of values, for instance, 1/0/1, 1/0/3-5, 1/0/7 indicates choosing port 1/0/1, 1/0/3, 1/0/4, 1/0/5, 1/0/7. 15 Chapter 2 2.1 User Interface enable Description The enable command is used to access Privileged EXEC Mode from User EXEC Mode. Syntax enable Command Mode User EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example If you have set the password to access Privileged EXEC Mode from User EXEC Mode: T1600G-28TS>enable Enter password: T1600G-28TS# 2.2 service password-encryption Description The service password-encryption command is used to encrypt the password when the password is defined or when the configuration is written, using the symmetric encryption algorithm. Encryption prevents the password from being readable in the configuration file. To disable the global encryption function, please use no service password-encryption command. Syntax service password-encryption no service password-encryption 16 Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the global encryption function: T1600G-28TS(config)# service password-encryption 2.3 enable password Description The enable password command is used to set or change the password for users to access Privileged EXEC Mode from User EXEC Mode. To remove the password, please use no enable password command. This command uses the symmetric encryption. Syntax enable password { [ 0 ] password | 7 encrypted-password } no enable password Parameter 0 —— Specify the encryption type. 0 indicates that an unencrypted password will follow. By default, the encryption type is 0. password —— Super password, a string from 1 to 31 alphanumeric characters or symbols. The password is case sensitive, allows digits, English letters (case sensitive), underlines ( !$%'()*,-./[]{|} ). By default, it is empty. and sixteen special characters 7 —— Indicates a symmetric encrypted password with fixed length will follow. encrypted-password —— A symmetric encrypted password with fixed length, which you can copy from another switch’s configuration file. After the encrypted password is configured, you should use the corresponding unencrypted password if you re-enter this mode. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode 17 Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. User Guidelines If the password you configured here is unencrypted and the global encryption function is enabled in service password-encryption, the password in the configuration file will be displayed in the symmetric encrypted form. Example Set the super password as “admin” and unencrypted to access Privileged EXEC Mode from User EXEC Mode: T1600G-28TS(config)#enable password 0 admin 2.4 enable secret Description The enable secret command is used to set a secret password, which is using an MD5 encryption algorithm, for users to access Privileged EXEC Mode from User EXEC Mode. To return to the default configuration, please use no enable secret command. This command uses the MD5 encryption. Syntax enable secret { [ 0 ] password | 5 encrypted-password } no enable secret Parameter 0 —— Specify the encryption type. 0 indicates that an unencrypted password will follow. By default, the encryption type is 0. password —— Super password, a string from 1 to 31 alphanumeric characters or symbols. The password is case sensitive, allows digits, English letters (case sensitive), underlines and sixteen special characters ( !$%'()*,-./[]{|} ). By default, it is empty. The password in the configuration file will be displayed in the MD5 encrypted form. 5 —— Indicates an MD5 encrypted password with fixed length will follow. encrypted-password —— An MD5 encrypted password with fixed length, which you can copy from another switch’s configuration file. After the 18 encrypted password is configured, you should use the corresponding unencrypted password if you re-enter this mode. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. User Guidelines If both the enable password and enable secret are defined, you must enter the password set in enable secret. Example Set the secret password as “admin” and unencrypted to access Privileged EXEC Mode from User EXEC Mode. The password will be displayed in the encrypted form. T1600G-28TS(config)#enable secret 0 admin 2.5 configure Description The configure command is used to access Global Configuration Mode from Privileged EXEC Mode. Syntax configure Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Access Global Configuration Mode from Privileged EXEC Mode: T1600G-28TS# configure T1600G-28TS(config)# 19 2.6 exit Description The exit command is used to return to the previous Mode from the current Mode. Syntax exit Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Return to Global Configuration Mode from Interface Configuration Mode, and then return to Privileged EXEC Mode: T1600G-28TS(config-if)# exit T1600G-28TS(config)#exit T1600G-28TS# 2.7 end Description The end command is used to return to Privileged EXEC Mode. Syntax end Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Return to Privileged EXEC Mode from Interface Configuration Mode: T1600G-28TS(config-if)#end T1600G-28TS# 20 2.8 clipaging Description The clipaging command is used to enable the pause function for the screen display. If you want to display all the related information of the switch at once when using the show command, please use no clipaging command. Syntax clipaging no clipaging Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Disable the pause function for the screen display: T1600G-28TS(config)#no clipaging 2.9 history Description The history command is used to show the latest 20 commands you entered in the current mode since the switch is powered. Syntax history Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Show the commands you have entered in the current mode: T1600G-28TS (config)# history 1 history 21 2.10 history clear Description The history clear command is used to clear the commands you have entered in the current mode, therefore these commands will not be shown next time you use the history command. Syntax history clear Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Clear the commands you have entered in the current mode: T1600G-28TS(config)#history clear 22 Chapter 3 User Management Commands User Management commands are used to manage the user’s logging information by Web, Telnet or SSH, so as to protect the settings of the switch from being randomly changed. 3.1 user name (password) Description The user name command is used to add a new user or modify the existed users’ information. To delete the existed users, please use no user name command. This command uses the symmetric encryption. Syntax user name name [ privilege admin | operator | power_user | user ] password { [ 0 ] password | 7 encrypted-password } no user name name Parameter name ——Type a name for users' login, which contains 16 characters at most, composed of digits, English letters and under dashes only. admin | operator | power_user | user —— Access level. “admin” means that you can edit, modify and view all the settings of different functions. “operator” means that you can edit, modify and view most of the settings of different functions. “power-user” means that you can edit, modify and view some of the settings of different functions. “user” means that you can only view some of the settings of different functions without the right to edit or modify. It is “admin” by default. For more details about privilege restrictions, please refer to the Privilege Requirement part in each command. 0 —— Specify the encryption type. 0 indicates that an unencrypted password will follow. By default, the encryption type is 0. password —— Users’ login password, a string from 1 to 31 alphanumeric characters or symbols. The password is case sensitive, allows digits, English letters (case ( !$%'()*,-./[]{|} ). sensitive), underlines and sixteen special characters 7 —— Indicates a symmetric encrypted password with fixed length will follow. encrypted-password —— A symmetric encrypted password with fixed length, which you can copy from another switch’s configuration file. After the 23 encrypted password is configured, you should use the corresponding unencrypted password if you re-enter this mode. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. User Guidelines If the password you configured here is unencrypted and the global encryption function is enabled in service password-encryption, the password in the configuration file will be displayed in the symmetric encrypted form. Example Add and enable a new admin user named “tplink”, of which the password is “admin” and unencrypted: T1600G-28TS(config)#user name tplink privilege admin password 0 admin 3.2 user name (secret) Description The user name command is used to add a new user or modify the existed users’ information. To delete the existed users, please use no user name command. This command uses the MD5 encryption. Syntax user name name [ privilege admin | operator | power_user | user ] secret { [ 0 ] password | 5 encrypted-password } no user name name Parameter name ——Type a name for users' login, which contains 16 characters at most, composed of digits, English letters and under dashes only. admin | operator | power_user | user —— Access level. “admin” means that you can edit, modify and view all the settings of different functions. “operator” means that you can edit, modify and view most of the the settings of different functions. “power-user” means that you can edit, modify and view some of 24 the the settings of different functions. “user” means that you can only view some of the the settings of different functions without the right to edit or modify. It is “admin” by default. 0 —— Specify the encryption type. 0 indicates that an unencrypted password will follow. By default, the encryption type is 0. password ——Users’ login password, a string from 1 to 31 alphanumeric characters or symbols. The password is case sensitive, allows digits, English letters (case sensitive), underlines and sixteen special characters ( !$%'()*,-./[]{|} ). The password will be saved to the configuration file using the MD5 encrypted algorithm. 5 —— Indicates an MD5 encrypted password with fixed length will follow. encrypted-password —— An MD5 encrypted password with fixed length, which you can copy from another switch’s configuration file. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. User Guidelines If both the user name (password) and user name (secret) are defined, only the latest configured password will take effect. Example Add and enable a new admin user named “tplink”, of which the password is “admin”. The password will be displayed in the encrypted form. T1600G-28TS(config)#user name tplink privilege admin secret 0 admin 3.3 show user account-list Description The show user account-list command is used to display the information of the current users. Syntax show user account-list Command Mode 25 Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the information of the current users: T1600G-28TS(config)# show user account-list 3.4 show user configuration Description The show user configuration command is used to display the security configuration information of the users, including access-control, max-number and the idle-timeout, etc. Syntax show user configuration Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the security configuration information of the users: T1600G-28TS(config)# show user configuration 26 Chapter 4 System Configuration Commands System Commands can be used to configure the System information and System IP, reboot and reset the switch, upgrade the switch system and other operations. 4.1 system-time manual Description The system-time manual command is used to configure the system time Syntax manually. system-time manual time Parameter time —— Set the date and time manually, MM/DD/YYYY-HH:MM:SS. The valid value of the year ranges from 2000 to 2037. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the system mode as manual, and the time is 12/20/2010 17:30:35 T1600G-28TS(config)# system-time manual 12/20/2010-17:30:35 4.2 system-time ntp Description Syntax The system-time ntp command is used to configure the time zone and the IP address for the NTP Server. The switch will get UTC automatically if it has connected to an NTP Server. system-time ntp { timezone } { ntp-server } { backup-ntp-server } { fetching-rate } Parameter timezone —— Your local time-zone, and it ranges from UTC-12:00 to UTC+13:00. 27 The detailed information that each time-zone means are displayed as follow: UTC-12:00 —— TimeZone for International Date Line West. UTC-11:00 —— TimeZone for Coordinated Universal Time-11. UTC-10:00 —— TimeZone for Hawaii. UTC-09:00 —— TimeZone for Alaska. UTC-08:00 —— TimeZone for Pacific Time(US Canada). UTC-07:00 —— TimeZone for Mountain Time(US Canada). UTC-06:00 —— TimeZone for Central Time(US Canada). UTC-05:00 —— TimeZone for Eastern Time(US Canada). UTC-04:30 —— TimeZone for Caracas. UTC-04:00 —— TimeZone for Atlantic Time(Canada). UTC-03:30 —— TimeZone for Newfoundland. UTC-03:00 —— TimeZone for Buenos Aires, Salvador, Brasilia. UTC-02:00 —— TimeZone for Mid-Atlantic. UTC-01:00 —— TimeZone for Azores, Cape Verde Is. UTC —— TimeZone for Dublin, Edinburgh, Lisbon, London. UTC+01:00 —— TimeZone for Amsterdam, Berlin, Bern, Rome, Stockholm, Vienna. UTC+02:00 —— TimeZone for Cairo, Athens, Bucharest, Amman, Beirut, Jerusalem. UTC+03:00 —— TimeZone for Kuwait, Riyadh, Baghdad. UTC+03:30 —— TimeZone for Tehran. UTC+04:00 —— TimeZone for Moscow, St.Petersburg, Volgograd, Tbilisi, Port Louis. UTC+04:30 —— TimeZone for Kabul. UTC+05:00 —— TimeZone for Islamabad, Karachi, Tashkent. UTC+05:30 —— TimeZone for Chennai, Kolkata, Mumbai, New Delhi. UTC+05:45 —— TimeZone for Kathmandu. UTC+06:00 —— TimeZone for Dhaka,Astana, Ekaterinburg. UTC+06:30 —— TimeZone for Yangon (Rangoon). UTC+07:00 —— TimeZone for Novosibrisk, Bangkok, Hanoi, Jakarta. UTC+08:00—— TimeZone for Beijing, Chongqing, Hong Kong, Urumqi, Singapore. UTC+09:00 —— TimeZone for Seoul, Irkutsk, Osaka, Sapporo, Tokyo. UTC+09:30 —— TimeZone for Darwin, Adelaide. UTC+10:00 —— TimeZone for Canberra, Melbourne, Sydney, Brisbane. UTC+11:00 —— TimeZone for Solomon Is., New Caledonia, Vladivostok. UTC+12:00 —— TimeZone for Fiji, Magadan, Auckland, Welington. UTC+13:00 —— TimeZone for Nuku'alofa, Samoa. ntp-server —— The IP address for the Primary NTP Server. 28 backup-ntp-server —— The IP address for the Secondary NTP Server. fetching-rate —— Specify the rate fetching time from NTP server. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the system time mode as NTP, the time zone is UTC-12:00, the primary NTP server is 133.100.9.2 and the secondary NTP server is 139.78.100.163, the fetching-rate is 11 hours: T1600G-28TS(config)# system-time ntp UTC-12:00 133.100.9.2 139.79.100.163 11 4.3 system-time dst predefined Description The system-time dst predefined command is used to select a daylight saving time configuration from the predefined mode. The configuration can be used recurrently. To disable DST function, please use no system-time dst Syntax command. system-time dst predefined [ USA | Australia | Europe | New-Zealand ] no system-time dst Parameter USA | Australia | Europe | New-Zealand —— The mode of daylight saving time. There are 4 options which are USA, Australia, Europe and New-Zealand respectively. The default value is Europe. Following are the time ranges of each option: USA —— Second Sunday in March, 02:00 ~ First Sunday in November, 02:00. Australia —— First Sunday in October, 02:00 ~ First Sunday in April, 03:00. Europe —— Last Sunday in March, 01:00 ~ Last Sunday in October, 01:00. New Zealand —— Last Sunday in September, 02:00 ~ First Sunday in April, 03:00. 29 Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the daylight saving time as USA standard: T1600G-28TS(config)#system-time dst predefined USA 4.4 system-time dst date Description The system-time dst date command is used to configure the one-off daylight saving time. The start date is in the current year by default. The time range of the daylight saving time must shorter than one year, but you can configure it spanning years. To disable DST function, please use no Syntax system-time dst command. system-time dst date {smonth } {sday } {stime } {syear } {emonth } {eday } {etime } {eyear }[offset ] no system-time dst Parameter smonth ——The start month of the daylight saving time. There are 12 values showing as follows: Jan, Feb, Mar, Apr, May, Jun, Jul, Aug, Sep, Oct, Nov, Dec. sday —— The start day of the daylight saving time, ranging from 1 to 31. Here you should show special attention to February and the differences between a solar month and a lunar month. stime —— The start moment of the daylight saving time, HH:MM. syear —— The start year of the daylight saving time. emonth —— The end month of the daylight saving time. There are 12 values showing as follows: Jan, Feb, Mar, Apr, May, Jun, Jul, Aug, Sep, Oct, Nov, Dec. eday —— The end day of the daylight saving time, ranging from q to 31. Here you should show special attention to February and the differences between a solar month and a lunar month. etime —— The end moment of the daylight saving time, HH:MM. eyear —— The end year of the daylight saving time. 30 offset —— The number of minutes to add during the daylight saving time. It is 60 minutes by default. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the daylight saving time from zero clock, Apr 1st to zero clock Oct 1st and the offset is 30 minutes in 2015: T1600G-28TS(config)# system-time dst date Apr 1 00:00 2015 Oct 1 00:00 2015 30 4.5 system-time dst recurring Description The system-time dst recurring command is used to configure the recurring daylight saving time. It can be configured spanning years. To disable DST Syntax function, please use no system-time dst command. system-time dst recurring {sweek} {sday} {smonth} {stime} {eweek} {eday} {emonth} {etime} [offset] no system-time dst Parameter sweek——The start week of the daylight saving time. There are 5 values showing as follows: first, second, third, fourth, last. sday —— The start day of the daylight saving time. There are 7 values showing as follows: Sun, Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat. smonth —— The start month of the daylight saving time. There are 12 values showing as follows: Jan, Feb, Mar, Apr, May, Jun, Jul, Aug, Sep, Oct, Nov, Dec. stime —— The start moment of the daylight saving time, HH:MM. eweek ——The end week of the daylight saving time. There are 5 values showing as follows: first, second, third, fourth, last. eday —— The end day of the daylight saving time. There are 5 values showing as follows: Sun, Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat. 31 emonth —— The end month of the daylight saving time. There are 12 values showing as following: Jan, Feb, Mar, Apr, May, Jun, Jul, Aug, Sep, Oct, Nov, Dec. etime —— The end moment of the daylight saving time, HH:MM. offset —— The number of minutes to add during the daylight saving time. It is 60 minutes by default. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the daylight saving time from 2:00am, the first Sunday of May to 2:00am, the last Sunday of Oct and the offset is 45 minutes: T1600G-28TS(config)# system-time dst recurring first Sun May 02:00 last Sun Oct 02:00 45 4.6 hostname Description The hostname command is used to configure the system name. To clear the Syntax system name information, please use no hostname command. hostname [ hostname ] no hostname Parameter hostname —— System Name. The length of the name ranges from 1 to 32 characters. By default, it is the device name, for example “T1600G-28TS”. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the system name as TPLINK: 32 T1600G-28TS(config)# hostname TPLINK 4.7 location Description The location command is used to configure the system location. To clear the Syntax system location information, please use no location command. location [ location ] no location Parameter location —— Device Location. It consists of 32 characters at most. It is “SHENZHEN” by default. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the system location as SHENZHEN: T1600G-28TS(config)# location SHENZHEN 4.8 contact-info Description The contact-info command is used to configure the system contact information. To clear the system contact information, please use no Syntax contact-info command. contact-info [ contact_info ] no contact-info Parameter contact_info —— Contact Information. It consists of 32 characters at most. It is “www.tp-link.com” by default. 33 Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the system contact information as www.tp-link.com: T1600G-28TS(config)# contact-info www.tp-link.com 4.9 ip address Description This ip address command is used to configure the IP address and IP subnet mask for the specified interface manually. The interface type includes: routed port, port-channel interface, loopback interface and VLAN interface. Syntax ip address { ip-addr } { mask } [ secondary ] no ip address [ ip-addr ] [ mask ] Parameter ip-addr —— The IP address of the Layer 3 interface. mask —— The subnet mask of the Layer 3 interface. secondary —— Specify the interface’s secondary IP address. If this parameter is omitted here, the configured IP address is the interface’s primary address. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create the VLAN interface 2 with the primary IP address as 192.168.1.1/24 and secondary IP address as 192.168.2.1/24: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 2 34 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0 secondary 4.10 ip address-alloc Description The IP address-alloc command is used to enable the DHCP Client function or the BOOTP Protocol. When this function is enabled, the specified interface will obtain IP from DHCP Server or BOOTP server. To disable the IP obtaining function on the specified interface, please use the no ip address command. This command applies to the routed port, the port-channel interface and the VLAN interface. Syntax ip address-alloc { dhcp | bootp } no ip address Parameter dhcp —— Specify the Layer 3 interface to obtain IP address from the DHCP Server. bootp —— Specify the Layer 3 interface to obtain IP address from the BOOTP Server. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the DHCP Client function on the Lay 3 routed port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no switchport T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip address-alloc dhcp Disable the IP address obtaining function on the VLAN interface 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no ip address 35 4.11 reset Description The reset command is used to reset the switch’s software. After resetting, all configuration of the switch will restore to the factory defaults and your Syntax current settings will be lost. reset Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Reset the software of the switch: T1600G-28TS# reset 4.12 reboot Description The reboot command is used to reboot the Switch. To avoid damage, please Syntax don’t turn off the device while rebooting. reboot Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Reboot the switch: T1600G-28TS# reboot 36 4.13 reboot-schedule Description This reboot-schedule command is used to configure the switch to reboot at a certain time point. To delete the reboot schedule settings, please use the reboot-schedule cancel command. Syntax reboot-schedule at time [ date ] [ save_before_reboot ] reboot-schedule in interval [ save_before_reboot ] reboot-schedule cancel Parameter time —— Specify the time point for the switch to reboot, in the format of hh:mm. date —— Specify the date for the switch to reboot, in the format of DD:MM:YYYY. The date should be within 30 days. save_before_reboot —— Save the configuration file before the switch reboots. interval —— Specify a time period after which the switch reboots. It ranges from 1 to 43200 minutes. cancel —— Delete the reboot schedule settings. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. User Guidelines In the command reboot-schedule at time [ date ] [ save_before_reboot ], if no date is specified and the time you set here is later than the time that this command is executed, the switch will reboot later that day; otherwise the switch will reboot at the time point the next day. Example Specify the switch to save the configuration files and reboot in 200 minutes,: T1600G-28TS(config)# reboot-schedule in 200 save_before_reboot 37 4.14 copy running-config startup-config Description The copy running-config startup-config command is used to save the Syntax current settings. copy running-config startup-config Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Save current settings: T1600G-28TS# copy running-config startup-config 4.15 copy startup-config tftp Description The copy startup-config tftp command is used to backup the configuration Syntax file to TFTP server. copy startup-config tftp ip-address ip-addr filename name Parameter ip-addr —— IP Address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234. name —— Specify the name for the configuration file which would be backup. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Backup the configuration files to TFTP server with the IP 192.168.0.148 and name this file config.cfg: 38 T1600G-28TS# copy startup-config tftp ip-address 192.168.0.148 filename config Backup the configuration files to TFTP server with the IP fe80::1234 and name this file config.cfg: T1600G-28TS# copy startup-config tftp ip-address fe80::1234 filename config 4.16 copy tftp startup-config Description The copy tftp startup-config command is used to download the Syntax configuration file to the switch from TFTP server. copy tftp startup-config ip-address ip-addr filename name Parameter ip-addr —— IP Address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234. name —— Specify the name for the configuration file which would be downloaded. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Download the configuration file named as config.cfg to the switch from TFTP server with the IP 192.168.0.148: T1600G-28TS# copy tftp startup-config ip-address 192.168.0.148 filename config Download the configuration file named as config.cfg to the switch from TFTP server with the IP fe80::1234 T1600G-28TS# copy tftp startup-config ip-address fe80::1234 filename config 39 4.17 copy backup-config tftp Description The copy backup-config tftp command is used to export the backup Syntax configuration file of the switch to TFTP server. copy backup-config tftp ip-address ip-addr filename name Parameter ip-addr —— IP Address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234. name —— Specify the name for the configuration file which would be exported. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Export the backup configuration file of the switch to the TFTP server with the IP 192.168.0.148 and name the file config.cfg: T1600G-28TS# copy backup-config tftp ip-address 192.168.0.148 filename config 4.18 copy backup-config startup-config Description The copy backup-config startup-config command is used to replace the Syntax startup configuration file using the backup configuration file. copy backup-config startup-config Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. 40 Example Replace the startup configuration file using the backup configuration file.: T1600G-28TS# copy backup-config startup-config 4.19 copy running-config backup-config Description The copy running-config backup-config tftp command is used to save the Syntax current running configuration as the backup configuration file. copy running-config backup-config Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Save the current running configuration as the backup configuration file. T1600G-28TS# copy running-config backup-config 4.20 copy tftp backup-config Description The copy tftp backup-config command is used to download the backup Syntax configuration file from a TFTP server. Copy tftp backup-config ip-address ip-addr filename name Parameter ip-addr —— IP Address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234. name —— Specify the name for the configuration file which would be downloaded. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement 41 Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Download the configuration file named config.cfg from the TFTP server with the IP 192.168.0.148: T1600G-28TS# copy tftp backup-config ip-address 192.168.0.148 filename config 4.21 boot application Description The boot application command is used to configure the image file as startup image or backup image. Syntax boot application filename { image1 | image 2 } { startup | backup } no boot application Parameter image1 | image2 —— Specify the image file to be configured. By default, the image1.bin is the startup image and the image2.bin is the backup image. startup | backup —— Specify the property of the image, either startup image or backup image. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the image2.bin as the startup image: T1600G-28TS(config)# boot application filename image2 startup 42 4.22 boot config Description The boot config command is used to configure the configuration file as startup configuration or backup configuration. Syntax boot config filename { config1 | config 2 } { startup | backup } no boot application Parameter config1 | config2 —— Specify the configuration file to be configured. By default, the config1.cfg is the startup image and the config2.cfg is the backup image. startup | backup—— Specify the property of the configuration. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the config2.cfg as the startup image: T1600G-28TS(config)# boot config filename config2 startup 4.23 remove backup-image Description The remove backup-image command is used to delete the backup-image. Syntax remove backup-image Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. 43 Example Delete the backup image file: T1600G-28TS# remove backup-image 4.24 firmware upgrade Description The firmware upgrade command is used to upgrade the switch’s backup iamge file via the TFTP server. The uploaded firmware file will take place of the Backup Image, and user can chose whether to reboot the switch will the Syntax Backup Image. firmware upgrade ip-address ip-addr filename name Parameter ip-addr —— IP Address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234. name —— Specify the name for the firmware file. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Upgrade the switch’s backup iamge file with the file firmware.bin in the TFTP server with the IP address 192.168.0.148, and reboot the switch with this firmware: T1600G-28TS# firmware upgrade ip-address 192.168.0.148 filename firmware.bin It will only upgrade the backup image. Continue? (Y/N):y Operation OK! Reboot with the backup image? (Y/N): y Upgrade the switch’s backup iamge file with the file firmware.bin in the TFTP server with the IP address fe80::1234, but do not reboot the switch: 44 T1600G-28TS# firmware upgrade ip-address fe80::1234 filename firmware.bin It will only upgrade the backup image. Continue? (Y/N):y Operation OK! Reboot with the backup image? (Y/N): n 4.25 ping Description The ping command is used to test the connectivity between the switch and Syntax one node of the network. ping [ ip | ipv6 ] { ip_addr } [ -n count ] [ -l size ] [ -i interval ] Parameter ip —— The type of the IP address for ping test should be IPv4. ipv6 —— The type of the IP address for ping test should be IPv6. ip_addr —— The IP address of the destination node for ping test. If the parameter ip/ipv6 is not selected, both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are supported, for example 192.168.0.100 or fe80::1234. -n count —— The amount of times to send test data during Ping testing. It ranges from 1 to 10. By default, this value is 4. -l size—— The size of the sending data during ping testing. It ranges from 1 to 1500 bytes. By default, this value is 64. -i interval —— The interval to send ICMP request packets. It ranges from 100 to 1000 milliseconds. By default, this value is 1000. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example To test the connectivity between the switch and the network device with the IP 192.168.0.131, please specify the count (-l) as 512 bytes and count (-i) as 1000 milliseconds. If there is not any response after 8 times’ Ping test, the connection between the switch and the network device is failed to establish: 45 T1600G-28TS# ping 192.168.0.131 –n 8 –l 512 To test the connectivity between the switch and the network device with the IP fe80::1234, please specify the count (-l) as 512 bytes and count (-i) as 1000 milliseconds. If there is not any response after 8 times’ Ping test, the connection between the switch and the network device is failed to establish: T1600G-28TS# ping fe80::1234 –n 8 –l 512 4.26 tracert Description The tracert command is used to test the connectivity of the gateways during Syntax its journey from the source to destination of the test data. tracert [ ip | ipv6 ] ip_addr [ maxHops ] Parameter ip —— The type of the IP address for tracert test should be IPv4. ipv6 —— The type of the IP address for tracert test should be IPv6. ip_addr —— The IP address of the destination device. If the parameter ip/ipv6 is not selected, both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are supported, for example 192.168.0.100 or fe80::1234. maxHops —— The maximum number of the route hops the test data can pass though. It ranges from 1 to 30. By default, this value is 4. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Test the connectivity between the switch and the network device with the IP 192.168.0.131. If the destination device has not been found after 20 maxHops, the connection between the switch and the destination device is failed to establish: T1600G-28TS# tracert 192.168.0.131 20 46 Test the connectivity between the switch and the network device with the IP fe80::1234. If the destination device has not been found after 20 maxHops, the connection between the switch and the destination device is failed to establish: T1600G-28TS# tracert fe80::1234 20 4.27 show system-info Description The show system-info command is used to display System Description, Device Name, Device Location, System Contact, Hardware Version, Firmware Syntax Version, System Time, Run Time and so on. show system-info Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the system information: T1600G-28TS# show system-info 4.28 show image-info Description The show image-info command is used to display the information of image files in the system. Syntax show image-info Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. 47 Example Display the system image files’ information: T1600G-28TS# show image-info 4.29 show boot Description The show boot command is used to display the boot configuration of the system. Syntax show boot Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the system boot configuration information: T1600G-28TS# show boot 4.30 show running-config Description The show running-config command is used to display the current operating Syntax configuration of the system or of a specified port. show running-config Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. 48 Example Display the system current operating configuration: T1600G-28TS# show running-config 4.31 show startup-config Description The show startup-config command is used to display the current configuration saved in the switch. These configuration settings will not be lost Syntax the next time you reboot the switch. show startup-config Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the saved configuration: T1600G-28TS# show startup-config 4.32 show system-time Description The show system-time command is used to display the time information of Syntax the switch. show system-time Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the time information of the switch T1600G-28TS# show system-time 49 4.33 show system-time dst Description The show system-time dst command is used to display the DST information Syntax of the switch. show system-time dst Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the DST information of the switch T1600G-28TS# show system-time dst 4.34 show system-time ntp Description The show system-time ntp command is used to display the NTP mode Syntax configuration information. show system-time ntp Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the NTP mode configuration information of the switch: T1600G-28TS# show system-time ntp 50 4.35 show cable-diagnostics interface Description The show cable-diagnostics interface command is used to display the cable diagnostics of the connected Ethernet Port., which facilitates you to check the connection status of the cable connected to the switch, locate and Syntax diagnose the trouble spot of the network. show cable-diagnostics interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port } Parameter port —— The number of the port which is selected for Cable test. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Show the cable-diagnostics of port 3: T1600G-28TS# show cable-diagnostics interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 4.36 show cpu-utilization Description The show cpu-utilization command is used to display the system’s CPU utilization in the last 5 seconds/1minute/5minutes. Syntax show cpu-utilization Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. 51 Example Display the CPU utilization information of the switch: T1600G-28TS# show cpu-utilization 4.37 show memory-utilization Description The show memory-utilization command is used to display the current system’s memory utilization in the last 5 seconds/1minute/5minutes. Syntax show memory-utilization Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the memory utilization information of the switch: T1600G-28TS# show memory-utilization 52 Chapter 5 EEE Configuration Commands EEE (Energy Efficient Ethernet) is used to save power consumption of the switch during periods of low data activity. You can simply enable this feature on ports to allow power reduction. 5.1 eee Description The eee command is used to enable EEE on the port. To disable EEE on the Syntax port, please use no eee command. eee no eee Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable EEE on port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#eee 5.2 show interface eee Description The show interface eee command is used to display the EEE configuration Syntax on each port. show interface eee [ fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port ] Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 53 Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the EEE configuration of each port T1600G-28TS# show interface eee 54 Chapter 6 SDM Template Commands This chapter describes how to configure the Switch Database Management (SDM) templates to allocate hardware resources on the switch for different uses. 6.1 sdm prefer Description The sdm prefer command is used to configure the SDM template. The SDM template is used to allocate system resources to best support the features being used in your application. To return to use the default template, please use the sdm prefer default command. The template change will takes effect after a reboot. Syntax sdm prefer { default | enterpriseV4 | enterpriseV6 } Parameter default —— Specify the SDM template used in the switch as “default”. enterpriseV4 —— Specify the SDM template used in the switch as “enterpriseV4”. enterpriseV6 —— Specify the SDM template used in the switch as “enterpriseV6”. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the SDM template as enterpriseV4: T1600G-28TS(config)# sdm prefer enterpriseV4 55 6.2 show sdm prefer Description The show sdm prefer command is used to display resource allocation of the current SDM template in use, or the SDM templates that can be used. Syntax show sdm prefer { used | default | enterpriseV4 | enterpriseV6 } Parameter used —— Display the resource allocation of the template currently in use, and the template that will become active after a reboot. default —— Display the resource allocation of the default template. enterpriseV4 —— Display the resource allocation of the enterpriseV4 template. enterpriseV6 —— Display the resource allocation of the enterpriseV6 template. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the resource allocation of the template currently in use, and the template that will become active after a reboot: T1600G-28TS(config)#show sdm prefer used 56 Chapter 7 Time Range Commands With this feature, you can configure a time range and bind it to a PoE port or an ACL rule. 7.1 time-range Description The time-range command is used to create time-range entry w for the switch and enter Time-range Create Configuration Mode. After a time-range entry is created, you need to specify the date and time. A time-range can implement multiple time-ranges simultaneously as long as they do not conflict with each other. To delete the corresponding time-range configuration, please use no Syntax time-range command. time-range name no time-range name Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Parameter name —— The time-range name, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create a time-range named “tRange1” for the switch: T1600G-28TS(config)# time-range tRange1 7.2 absolute Description The absolute command is used to create an absolute time-range for the time-range of the switch. To delete the corresponding absolute time-range configuration, please use no absolute command. 57 Syntax absolute from start-date to end-date no absolute [index ] Parameter start-date —— The start date in Absoluteness Mode, in the format of MM/DD/YYYY. end-date —— The end date in Absoluteness Mode, in the format of MM/DD/YYYY. Command Mode Power Time-range Create Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create an absolute time-range for the switch and specify the date extending from May 5th, 2017 through Oct. 5th, 2017: T1600G-28TS(config)#time-range tRange1 T1600G-28TS(config-time-range)#absolute from 05/05/2017 to 10/05/2017 7.3 periodic Description The periodic command is used to create a periodic mode time-range for the time-range of the switch. To delete the corresponding periodic mode Syntax time-range configuration, please use no periodic command. periodic { [start start-time ] [ end end-time ] [day-of-the-week week-day ] no periodic [ index ] Parameter start-time——Specify the start time in the format of HH:MM end-time——Specify the end time in the format of HH:MM week-day ——Specify the days of a week in the format of 1-3, 7. The numbers 1-7 respectively represent Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday, Thursday, Friday, Saturday and Sunday. 58 Command Mode Power Time-range Create Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the time-range named “tRange2” as a periodic time-range and specify the date and time as 8:30 to 12:00 on weekends: T1600G-28TS(config)#time-range tRange2 T1600G-28TS(config -time-range)#periodic start 08:30 end 12:00 day-of-the-week 6-7 7.4 holiday (time-range mode) Description The holiday command is used to create holiday mode time-range for the time-range of the switch. When the holiday which is excluded from Syntax time-range occurs, the switch will not supply power. holiday { exclude | include } Parameter exclude ——The time range will not take effect on holiday. include —— The time range will take effect on holiday. Command Mode Power Time-range Create Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create a time-range entry named “tRange3” and configure time-range to exclude the holiday: T1600G-28TS(config)#time-range tRange3 T1600G-28TS(config-time-range)#holiday exclude 59 7.5 holiday Description The holiday command is used to create holiday for the switch. To delete the Syntax corresponding holiday configuration, please use no holiday command. holiday name start-date start-date end-date end-date no holiday name Parameter name —— The holiday name, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. start-date —— The start date of the holiday, in the format of MM/DD, for instance, 05/01. end-date ——The end date of the holiday, in the format of MM/DD, for instance, 05/01. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create a holiday named “holiday1” and configure the start date as October 1st and the end date as October 3rd: T1600G-28TS(config)# holiday holiday1 start-date 10/01 end-date 10/03 7.6 show holiday Description Syntax The show holiday command is used to display the defined holiday. show holiday Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. 60 Example Display the defined holiday: T1600G-28TS# show holiday 7.7 show time-range Description Syntax The show holiday command is used to display the defined holiday. show time-range Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the defined holiday: T1600G-28TS# show holiday 61 Chapter 8 Port Configuration Commands Ethernet Configuration Commands can be used to configure the Bandwidth Control, Negotiation Mode and Storm Control for Ethernet ports. 8.1 interface gigabitEthernet Description The interface gigabitEthernet command is used to enter the Interface gigabitEthernet Configuration Mode and configure the corresponding Gigabit Ethernet port. Syntax interface gigabitEthernet port Parameter port —— The Ethernet port number. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example To enter the Interface gigabitEthernet Configuration Mode and configure port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 8.2 interface range gigabitEthernet Description The interface range gigabitEthernet command is used to enter the interface range gigabitEthernet Configuration Mode and configure multiple Gigabit Ethernet ports at the same time. 62 Syntax interface range gigabitEthernet port-list Parameter port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. User Guidelines Command in the Interface Range gigabitEthernet Mode is executed independently on all ports in the range. It does not affect the execution on the other ports at all if the command results in an error on one port. Example To enter the Interface range gigabitEthernet Configuration Mode, and configure ports 1, 2, 3, 6, 7 and 9 at the same time by adding them to one port-list: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-3,1/0/6-7,1/0/9 8.3 description Description The description command is used to add a description to the Ethernet port. To clear the description of the corresponding port, please use no description command. Syntax description string no description Parameter string —— Content of a port description, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. 63 Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Add a description Port_5 to port 1/0/5: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# description Port_5 8.4 shutdown Description The shutdown command is used to disable an Ethernet port. To enable this Syntax port again, please use no shutdown command. shutdown no shutdown Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Disable port 1/0/3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# shutdown 64 8.5 flow-control Description The flow-control command is used to enable the flow-control function for a port. To disable the flow-control function for this corresponding port, please use no flow-control command. With the flow-control function enabled, the Ingress Rate and Egress Rate can be synchronized to avoid packet loss in the Syntax network. flow-control no flow-control Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the flow-control function for port 1/0/3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# flow-control 8.6 duplex Description The duplex command is used to configure the Duplex Mode for an Ethernet port. To return to the default configuration, please use no duplex command. Syntax duplex { auto | full | half } no duplex Parameter auto | full | half —— The duplex mode of the Ethernet port. There are three options: auto-negotiation mode, full-duplex mode and half-duplex mode. By default the Gigabit Ethernet port is auto-negotiation mode. 65 Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the Duplex Mode as full-duplex for port 1/0/3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# duplex full 8.7 jumbo-size Description Syntax The jumbo-size command is used to specify the size of jumbo frames. jumbo-size size Parameter size —— The value of jumbo frames. It ranges from 1518 to 9216 bytes, and the default is 1518 bytes. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Globally configure the size of jumbo frames as 9216: T1600G-28TS(config)# jumbo-size 9216 8.8 speed Description The speed command is used to configure the Speed Mode for an Ethernet port. To return to the default configuration, please use no speed command. 66 Syntax speed { 10 | 100 | 1000 | auto } no speed Parameter 10 | 100 | 1000 | auto —— The speed mode of the Ethernet port. There are four options: 10Mbps, 100Mbps, 1000Mbps and Auto negotiation mode (default). Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the Speed Mode as 100Mbps for port 1/0/3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# speed 100 8.9 clear counters Description The clear counters command is used to clear the statistics information of all Syntax the Ethernet ports and port channels. clear counters clear counters interface [ gigabitEthernet port ] [ port-channel port-channel-id ] Parameter port —— The Ethernet port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. 67 Example Clear the statistic information of all ports and port channels: T1600G-28TS(config)# clear counters 8.10 show interface status Description The show interface status command is used to display the connection Syntax status of the Ethernet port/port channel. show interface port-channel-id ] status [ gigabitEthernet port ] [ port-channel Parameter port —— The Ethernet port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the connection status of all ports and port channels: T1600G-28TS(config)# show interface status Display the connection status of port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)# show interface status gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 8.11 show interface counters Description The show interface counters command is used to display the statistics Syntax information of all ports/port channels. show interface counters [ gigabitEthernet port ] [ port-channel port-channel-id ] Parameter port —— The Ethernet port number. 68 port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the statistics information of all Ethernet ports and port channels: T1600G-28TS(config)# show interface counters Display the statistics information of port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)# show interface counters gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 8.12 show interface configuration Description The show interface configuration command is used to display the configurations of all ports and port channels, including Port-status, Flow Syntax Control, Negotiation Mode and Port-description. show interface configuration [ gigabitEthernet port ] [ port-channel port-channel-id ] Parameter port —— The Ethernet port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configurations of all Ethernet ports and port channels: T1600G-28TS(config)# show interface configuration Display the configurations of port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)# show interface configuration gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 69 Chapter 9 Port Isolation Commands Port Isolation provides a method of restricting traffic flow to improve the network security by forbidding the port to forward packets to the ports that are not on its forwarding port list. 9.1 port isolation Description The port isolation command is used to configure the forward port/port channel list of a port/port channel, so that this port/port channel can only communicate with the ports/port channels on its list. To delete the Syntax corresponding configuration, please use no port isolation command. port isolation { [ fa-forward-list fa-forward-list ] [ gi-forward-list gi-forward-list ] [ po-forward-list po-forward-list ] [ te-forward-list te-forward-list ] } no port isolation Parameter fa-forward-list / gi-forward-list / te-forward-list —— The list of Ethernet ports. po-forward-list —— The list of port channels. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Set port 1, 2, 4 and port channel 2 to the forward list of port 1/0/5: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# port isolation gi-forward-list 1/0/1-2,1/0/4 po-forward-list 2 Set all Ethernet ports and port channels to forward list of port 1/0/2, namely restore to the default setting: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 70 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no port isolation 9.2 show port isolation interface Description The show port isolation interface command is used to display the forward Syntax port list of a port/port channel. show port isolation interface [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] Parameter port —— The number of Ethernet port you want to show its forward port list, in the format of 1/0/2. port-channel-id —— The ID of port channel you want to show its forward port list, ranging from 1 to 6. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the forward-list of port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS# show port isolation interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 Display the forward-list of all Ethernet ports and port channels: T1600G-28TS# show port isolation interface 71 Chapter 10 Loopback Detection Commands With loopback detection feature enabled, the switch can detect loops using loopback detection packets. When a loop is detected, the switch will display an alert or further block the corresponding port according to the configuration. 10.1 loopback-detection (global) Description The loopback-detection command is used to enable the loopback detection Syntax function globally. To disable it, please use no loopback detection command. loopback-detection no loopback-detection Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the loopback detection function globally: T1600G-28TS(config)# loopback-detection 10.2 loopback-detection interval Description The loopback-detection interval command is used to define the interval of sending loopback detection packets from switch ports to network, aiming at Syntax detecting network loops periodically. loopback-detection interval interval-time Parameter interval-time —— The interval of sending loopback detection packets. It ranges from 1 to 1000 seconds. By default, this value is 30. 72 Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the interval-time as 50 seconds: T1600G-28TS(config)# loopback-detection interval 50 10.3 loopback-detection recovery-time Description The loopback-detection recovery-time command is used to configure the time after which the blocked port would automatically recover to normal Syntax status. loopback-detection recovery-time recovery-time Parameter recovery-time —— The time after which the blocked port would automatically recover to normal status, and the loopback detection would restart. It ranges from 2 to 1000000 seconds. By default, this value is 90. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the recovery-time as 70 seconds: T1600G-28TS(config)# loopback-detection recovery-time 70 73 10.4 loopback-detection (interface) Description The loopback-detection command is used to enable the loopback detection function of the specified port. To disable it, please use no Syntax loopback-detection command. loopback-detection no loopback-detection Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet | interface range gigabitEthernet | interface port-channel | interface range port-channel ) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the loopback detection function of ports 1-3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-3 T1600G-28TS(Config-if-range)# loopback-detection 10.5 loopback-detection config process-mode Description The loopback-detection config process-mode command is used to configure the process-mode for the ports by which the switch copes with the detected loops. You also need to configure the recovery mode to remove the block status of the port or VLAN when the process-mode is Port Based or Syntax VLAN Based. loopback-detection config process-mode { alert | port-based | vlan-based } recovery-mode { auto | manual } Parameter alert —— When a loop is detected, the switch will send a trap message and generate an entry on the log file. It is the default setting. port-based —— When a loop is detected, the switch will send a trap message and generate an entry on the log file. In addition, the switch will block the port 74 on which the loop is detected and no packets can pass through the port. vlan-based —— When a loop is detected, the switch will send a trap message and generate an entry on the log file. In addition, the switch will block the VLAN in which the loop is detected and only the packets of the blocked VLAN cannot pass through the port. auto —— Block status can be automatically removed after recovery time. manual —— Block status can only be removed manually. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet | interface range gigabitEthernet | interface port-channel | interface range port-channel ) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the loopback detection process-mode as port-based, and configure the recovery mode as manual for port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# loopback-detection config process-mode port-based recovery-mode manual 10.6 loopback-detection recover Description The loopback-detection recover command is used to remove the block Syntax status of selected ports, recovering the blocked ports to normal status, loopback-detection recover Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet | interface range gigabitEthernet | interface port-channel | interface range port-channel ) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Recover the blocked port 1/0/2 to normal status: 75 T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# loopback-detection recover 10.7 show loopback-detection global Description The show loopback-detection global command is used to display the global configuration of loopback detection function such as loopback detection global status, loopback detection interval and loopback detection recovery Syntax time. show loopback-detection global Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the global configuration of loopback detection function: T1600G-28TS# show loopback-detection global 10.8 show loopback-detection interface Description The show loopback-detection interface command is used to display the configuration of loopback detection function and the status of the specified Syntax Ethernet port. show loopback-detection interface [ gigabitEthernet port | port-channel lagid ] [ detail ] Parameter port —— The Ethernet port number. lagid —— The number of LAG, ranging from 1 to 14. detail —— Displays the loop status and block status of the VLAN which the specified port belongs to. 76 Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configuration of loopback detection function and the status of all ports: T1600G-28TS# show loopback-detection interface Display the configuration of loopback detection function and the status of port 5: T1600G-28TS# show loopback-detection interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 77 Chapter 11 Etherchannel Commands Etherchannel Commands are used to configure LAG and LACP function. LAG (Link Aggregation Group) is to combine a number of ports together to make a single high-bandwidth data path, which can highly extend the bandwidth. The bandwidth of the LAG is the sum of bandwidth of its member port. LACP (Link Aggregation Control Protocol) is defined in IEEE802.3ad and enables the dynamic link aggregation and disaggregation by exchanging LACP packets with its partner. The switch can dynamically group similarly configured ports into a single logical link, which will highly extend the bandwidth and flexibly balance the load. 11.1 channel-group Description The channel-group command is used to add a port to the EtherChannel Group and configure its mode. To delete the port from the EtherChannel Group, please use no channel-group command. Syntax channel-group num mode { on | active | passive } no channel-group Parameter num —— The number of the EtherChannel Group, ranging from 1 to 14. on —— Enable the static LAG. active —— Enable the active LACP mode. passive —— Enable the passive LACP mode. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 78 Example Add ports 2-4 to EtherChannel Group 1 and enable the static LAG: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-4 T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)# channel-group 1 mode on 11.2 port-channel load-balance Description The port-channel load-balance command is used to configure the Aggregate Arithmetic for LAG. To return to the default configurations, please use no port-channel load-balance command. Syntax port-channel load-balance { src-mac | dst-mac | src-dst-mac | src-ip | dst-ip | src-dst-ip } no port-channel load-balance Parameter src-mac —— The source MAC address. When this option is selected, the Aggregate Arithmetic will be based on the source MAC address of the packets. dst-mac —— The destination MAC address. When this option is selected, the Aggregate Arithmetic will be based on the destination MAC address of the packets. src-dst-mac —— The source and destination MAC address. When this option is selected, the Aggregate Arithmetic will be based on the source and destination MAC addresses of the packets. The Aggregate Arithmetic for LAG is “src-dst-mac” by default. src-ip —— The source IP address. When this option is selected, the Aggregate Arithmetic will be based on the source IP address of the packets. dst-ip —— The destination IP address. When this option is selected, the Aggregate Arithmetic will be based on the destination IP address of the packets. src-dst-ip —— The source and destination IP address. When this option is selected, the Aggregate Arithmetic will be based on the source and destination IP addresses of the packets. 79 Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the Aggregate Arithmetic for LAG as “src-dst-ip”: T1600G-28TS(config)# port-channel load-balance src-dst-ip 11.3 lacp system-priority Description The lacp system-priority command is used to configure the LACP system priority globally. To return to the default configurations, please use no lacp system-priority command. Syntax lacp system-priority pri no lacp system-priority Parameter pri —— The system priority, ranging from 0 to 65535. It is 32768 by default. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the LACP system priority as 1024 globally: T1600G-28TS(config)# lacp system-priority 1024 80 11.4 lacp port-priority Description The lacp port-priority command is used to configure the LACP port priority for specified ports. To return to the default configurations, please use no lacp port-priority command. Syntax lacp port-priority pri no lacp port-priority Parameter pri —— The port priority, ranging from 0 to 65535. It is 32768 by default. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the LACP port priority as 1024 for ports 1-3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-3 T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)# lacp port-priority 1024 Configure the LACP port priority as 2048 for port 4: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/4 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# lacp port-priority 2048 11.5 show etherchannel Description The show etherchannel command is used to display the EtherChannel Syntax information. show etherchannel [ channel-group-num ] { detail | summary } 81 Parameter channel-group-num —— The EtherChannel Group number, ranging from 1 to 14. By default, it is empty, and will display the information of all EtherChannel Groups. detail —— The detailed information of EtherChannel. summary —— The EtherChannel information in summary. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the detailed information of EtherChannel Group 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# show etherchannel 1 detail 11.6 show etherchannel load-balance Description The show etherchannel load-balance command is used to display the Aggregate Arithmetic of LAG. Syntax show etherchannel load-balance Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the Aggregate Arithmetic of LAG: T1600G-28TS(config)# show etherchannel load-balance 82 11.7 show lacp Description The show lacp command is used to display the LACP information for a specified EtherChannel Group. Syntax show lacp [ channel-group-num ] { internal | neighbor } Parameter channel-group-num —— The EtherChannel Group number, ranging from 1 to 14. By default, it is empty, and will display the information of all LACP groups. internal —— The internal LACP information. neighbor —— The neighbor LACP information. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the internal LACP information of EtherChannel Group 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# show lacp 1 internal 11.8 show lacp sys-id Description The show lacp sys-id command is used to display the LACP system priority globally. Syntax show lacp sys-id Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. 83 Example Display the LACP system priority: T1600G-28TS(config)# show lacp sys-id 84 Chapter 12 MAC Address Commands MAC Address configuration can improve the network security by configuring the Port Security and maintaining the address information by managing the Address Table. 12.1 mac address-table static Description The mac address-table static command is used to add the static MAC address entry. To remove the corresponding entry, please use no mac address-table static command. The static address can be added or removed manually, independent of the aging time. In the stable networks, the static MAC address entries can facilitate the switch to reduce broadcast packets Syntax and enhance the efficiency of packets forwarding remarkably. mac address-table static mac-addr vid vid interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port } no mac address-table static mac-addr vid vid interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port } Parameter mac-addr ——The MAC address of the entry you desire to add. vid —— The VLAN ID number of your desired entry. It ranges from 1 to 4094. port —— The Ethernet port number of your desired entry. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Add a static Mac address entry to bind the MAC address 00:02:58:4f:6c:23, VLAN1 and port 1 together: T1600G-28TS(config)# mac address-table static 00:02:58:4f:6c:23 vid 1 interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 85 12.2 mac address-table aging-time Description The mac address-table aging-time command is used to configure aging time for the dynamic address. To return to the default configuration, please Syntax use no mac address-table aging-time command. mac address-table aging-time aging-time no mac address-table aging-time Parameter aging-time —— The aging time for the dynamic address. The value of it can be 0 or ranges from 10 to 630 seconds. When 0 is entered, the Auto Aging function is disabled. It is 300 by default. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the aging time as 500 seconds: T1600G-28TS(config)# mac address-table aging-time 500 12.3 mac address-table filtering Description The mac address-table filtering command is used to add the filtering address entry. To delete the corresponding entry, please use no mac address-table filtering command. The filtering address function is to forbid the undesired package to be forwarded. The filtering address can be added Syntax or removed manually, independent of the aging time. mac address-table filtering mac-addr vid vid no mac address-table filtering {[ mac-addr ] [ vid vid ]} Parameter mac-addr —— The MAC address to be filtered. 86 vid —— The corresponding VLAN ID of the MAC address. It ranges from 1 to 4094. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Add a filtering address entry of which VLAN ID is 1 and MAC address is 00:1e:4b:04:01:5d: T1600G-28TS(config)# mac address-table filtering 00:1e:4b:04:01:5d vid 1 12.4 mac address-table max-mac-count Description The mac address-table max-mac-count command is used to configure the Port Security. To return to the default configurations, please use no mac address-table max-mac-count command. Port Security is to protect the switch from the malicious MAC address attack by limiting the maximum number of the MAC addresses that can be learned on the port. The port with Port Security feature enabled will learned the MAC address dynamically. When the learned MAC address number reaches the maximum, the port will stop learning. Therefore, the other devices with the MAC address unlearned Syntax cannot access to the network via this port. mac address-table max-mac-count { [ max-number num ] [ mode { dynamic | static | permanent } ] [ status { forward | drop | disable } ] [ exceed-max-learned enable | disable ] } no mac address-table max-mac-count [ max-number | mode | status ] Parameter num —— The maximum number of MAC addresses that can be learned on the port. It ranges from 0 to 64. By default this value is 64. dynamic | static | permanent —— Learn mode for MAC addresses. There are three modes, including Dynamic mode, Static mode and Permanent mode. When Dynamic mode is selected, the learned MAC address will be deleted automatically after the aging time. When Static mode is selected, the learned 87 MAC address will be out of the influence of the aging time and can only be deleted manually. The learned entries will be cleared after the switch is rebooted. When permanent mode is selected, the learned MAC address will be out of the influence of the aging time and can only be deleted manually too. However, the learned entries will be saved even the switch is rebooted. status —— Select the action to be taken when the number of the MAC addresses reaches the maximum learning number on the port. By default this function is disabled. • forward: The packets will be forward but not be learned when learned MAC number exceeds the maximum MAC address number on this port. • drop: The packets will be dropped when learned MAC number exceeds the maximum MAC address number on this port. • disable: The MAC address threshold on this port is disabled. new-mac-learned enable | disable —— Enable/Disable the new-mac-learned notification on this port. With this feature enabled, a SNMP notification is generated and sent to the network management system (NMS) when the port learns a new MAC address. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable Port Security function for port 1/0/1, select Static mode as the learn mode, and specify the maximum number of MAC addresses that can be learned on this port as 30. When the number of MAC address entries reaches 30 on this port, new entry will be dropped: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# mac address-table max-mac-count max-number 30 mode static status drop 88 12.5 show mac address-table Description The show mac address-table command is used to display the information of Syntax all address entries. show mac address-table { dynamic | static | filtering } Parameter dynamic | static | filtering —— The type of your desired entry. By default all the entries are displayed. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the information of all address entries: T1600G-28TS(config)# show mac address-table 12.6 clear mac address-table Description The show mac address-table command is used to clear the specified Syntax address entries. clear mac address-table { dynamic | static | filtering } Parameter dynamic | static | filtering —— The type of your desired entry. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Clear the information of all static address entries: 89 T1600G-28TS(config)# clear mac address-table static 12.7 show mac address-table aging-time Description The show mac address-table aging-time command is used to display the Syntax Aging Time of the MAC address. show mac address-table aging-time Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the Aging Time of the MAC address: T1600G-28TS(config)# show mac address-table aging-time 12.8 show mac address-table max-mac-count Description The show mac address-table max-mac-count interface gigabitEthernet command is used to display the security configuration of all ports or the Syntax specified port. show mac address-table max-mac-count { all | interface gigabitEthernet port } Parameter all —— Displays the security information of all the Ethernet ports. port —— The Ethernet port number. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. 90 Example Display the security configuration of all ports: T1600G-28TS(config)# show mac address-table max-mac-count all Display the security configuration of port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)# show mac address-table max-mac-count interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 12.9 show mac address-table interface Description The show mac address-table interface command is used to display the Syntax address configuration of the specified port/port channel. show mac address-table interface { gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id } Parameter port —— The Ethernet port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the address configuration of port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)# show mac address-table interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 12.10 show mac address-table count Description The show mac address-table count command is used to display the total Syntax amount of MAC address table. show mac address-table count [ vlan vlan-id ] 91 Parameter vlan-id —— Specify the VLAN which the MAC entries belong to. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the total MAC entry information in different VLANs: T1600G-28TS(config)# show mac address-table count 12.11 show mac address-table address Description The show mac address-table address command is used to display the Syntax information of the specified MAC address. show mac address-table address mac-addr [ interface { gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id } | vid vlan-id ] Parameter mac-addr ——The specified MAC address. port —— The Ethernet port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. vlan-id —— Specify the VLAN which the entry belongs to. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the information of the MAC address 00:00:00:00:23:00 in VLAN 1: T1600G-28TS(config)#show mac address-table address 00:00:00:00:23:00 vid 1 92 12.12 show mac address-table vlan Description The show mac address-table vlan command is used to display the MAC Syntax address configuration of the specified vlan. show mac address-table vlan vid Parameter vid ——The specified VLAN id. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the MAC address configuration of vlan 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# show mac address-table vlan 1 93 Chapter 13 IEEE 802.1Q VLAN Commands VLAN (Virtual Local Area Network) technology is developed for the switch to divide the LAN into multiple logical LANs flexibly. Hosts in the same VLAN can communicate with each other, regardless of their physical locations. VLAN can enhance performance by conserving bandwidth, and improve security by limiting traffic to specific domains. 13.1 vlan Description The vlan command is used to create IEEE 802.1Q VLAN and enter VLAN Configuration Mode. To delete the IEEE 802.1Q VLAN, please use no vlan command. Syntax vlan vlan-list no vlan vlan-list Parameter vlan-list —— Specify IEEE 802.1Q VLAN ID list, ranging from 2 to 4094, in the format of 2-3, 5. It is multi-optional. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create VLAN 2-10 and VLAN 100: T1600G-28TS(config)# vlan 2-10,100 Delete VLAN 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# no vlan 2 94 13.2 name Description The name command is used to assign a description to a VLAN. To clear the description, please use no name command. Syntax name descript no name Parameter descript ——String to describe the VLAN, which contains 16 characters at most. Command Mode VLAN Configuration Mode(VLAN) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the name of VLAN 2 as “group1”: T1600G-28TS(config)# vlan 2 T1600G-28TS(config-vlan)# name group1 13.3 switchport general allowed vlan Description The switchport general allowed vlan command is used to add the desired port to IEEE 802.1Q VLAN, or to remove a port from the corresponding VLAN. Syntax switchport general allowed vlan vlan-list { tagged | untagged } no switchport general allowed vlan vlan-list Parameter vlan-list —— VLAN ID list, ranging from 2 to 4094, in the format of 2-3, 5. It is multi-optional. 95 tagged | untagged —— egress-rule. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/4 whose link type is “general” to VLAN 2 and its egress-rule as “tagged”: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/4 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#switchport mode general T1600G-28TS(config-if)#switchport general allowed vlan 2 tagged 13.4 switchport pvid Description The switchport pvid command is used to configure the PVID for the switch ports. Syntax switchport pvid vlan-id Parameter vlan-id —— VLAN ID, ranging from 1 to 4094. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the PVID of port 1/0/2 as 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 96 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# switchport pvid 2 13.5 switchport check ingress Description The switchport check ingress command is used to enable the Ingress Checking function for the switch ports. With this function enabled, the port will accept the packet of which the VLAN ID is in the port's VLAN list and discard others. With this function disabled, the port will forward the packet directly. To disable this function, please use no switchport check ingress command. Syntax switchport check ingress no switchport check ingress Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable Ingress Checking on the port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# switchport check ingress 13.6 switchport acceptable frame Description The switchport acceptable frame command is used to specify the acceptable frame type for the switch ports and the ports will perform this operation before Ingress Checking. To restore to the default setting, please use no switchport acceptable frame command. Syntax switchport acceptable frame { all | tagged } 97 no switchport acceptable frame Parameter all | tagged —— the acceptable frame type. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the acceptable frame type of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/4 as “tagged”: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/4 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#switchport acceptable frame general 13.7 show vlan summary Description The show vlan summary command is used to display the summarized information of IEEE 802.1Q VLAN. Syntax show vlan summary Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the summarized information of IEEE 802.1Q VLAN: T1600G-28TS(config)# show vlan summary 98 13.8 show vlan brief Description The show vlan brief command is used to display the brief information of IEEE 802.1Q VLAN. Syntax show vlan brief Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the brief information of IEEE 802.1Q VLAN: T1600G-28TS(config)# show vlan brief 13.9 show vlan Description The show vlan command is used to display the information of IEEE 802.1Q VLAN. Syntax show vlan [ id vlan-id ] Parameter vlan-id —— Specify IEEE 802.1Q VLAN ID, ranging from 1 to 4094. It is multi-optional. Using the show vlan command without parameter displays the detailed information of all VLANs. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. 99 Example Display the information of vlan 5: T1600G-28TS(config)# show vlan id 5 13.10 show interface switchport Description The show interface switchport command is used to display the IEEE 802.1Q VLAN configuration information of the specified port/port channel. Syntax show interface switchport [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] Parameter port —— The port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the VLAN configuration information of all ports and port channels: T1600G-28TS(config)# show interface switchport 100 Chapter 14 MAC-based VLAN Commands MAC VLAN (Virtual Local Area Network) is the way to classify the VLANs based on MAC Address. A MAC address is relative to a single VLAN ID. The untagged packets and the priority-tagged packets coming from the MAC address will be tagged with this VLAN ID. 14.1 mac-vlan mac-address Description The mac-vlan mac-address command is used to create a MAC-based VLAN entry. To delete a MAC-based VLAN entry, please use the no mac-vlan mac-address command. Syntax mac-vlan mac-address mac-addr vlan vlan-id [description descript] no mac-vlan mac-address mac-addr Parameter mac-addr —— MAC address, in the format of XX:XX:XX:XX:XX:XX. vlan-id —— Specify IEEE 802.1Q VLAN ID, ranging from 1 to 4094. descript —— Give a description to the MAC address for identification, which contains 8 characters at most. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create VLAN 2 with the MAC address 00:11:11:01:01:12 and the name “TP”: T1600G-28TS(config)#mac-vlan mac-address 00:11:11:01:01:12 vlan 2 description TP 101 14.2 mac-vlan Description The mac-vlan command is used to enable a port for the MAC-based VLAN feature. Only the port is enabled can the configured MAC-based VLAN take effect. To disable the MAC-based VLAN function, please use no mac-vlan command. All the ports are disabled by default. Syntax mac-vlan no mac-vlan Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/3 for the MAC-based VLAN feature: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#mac-vlan 14.3 show mac-vlan Description The show mac-vlan command is used to display the information of the MAC-based VLAN entry. MAC address and VLAN ID can be used to filter the displayed information. Syntax show mac-vlan { all | mac-address mac-addr | vlan vlan-id } Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 102 Privilege Requirement None. Parameter mac-addr —— MAC address, in the format of XX:XX:XX:XX:XX:XX. vlan-id —— Specify IEEE 802.1Q VLAN ID, ranging from 1 to 4094. Example Display the information of all the MAC-based VLAN entry: T1600G-28TS(config)#show mac-vlan all 14.4 show mac-vlan interface Description The show mac-vlan interface command is used to display the port state of MAC-based VLAN. Syntax show mac-vlan interface Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the enable state of all the ports: T1600G-28TS(config)#show mac-vlan interface 103 Chapter 15 Protocol-based VLAN Commands Protocol VLAN (Virtual Local Area Network) is the way to classify VLANs based on Protocols. A Protocol is relative to a single VLAN ID. The untagged packets and the priority-tagged packets matching the protocol template will be tagged with this VLAN ID. 15.1 protocol-vlan template Description The protocol-vlan template command is used to create Protocol-based VLAN template. To delete Protocol-based VLAN template, please use no protocol-vlan template command. Syntax protocol-vlan template name protocol-name frame { ether_2 ether-type type | snap ether-type type | llc dsap dsap_type ssap ssap_type } no protocol-vlan template template-idx Parameter protocol-name —— Give a name for the Protocol-based VLAN Template , which contains 8 characters at most. ether_2 ether-type type —— Specify the Ethernet type. snap ether-type type —— Specify the Ethernet type. llc dsap dsap_type ssap ssap_type —— Specify the DSAP type and the SSAP type. template-idx —— The number of the Protocol-based VLAN Template. You can get the template corresponding to the number by the show protocol-vlan template command. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 104 Example Create a Protocol-based VLAN template named “TP” whose Ethernet protocol type is 0x2024: T1600G-28TS(config)#protocol-vlan template name TP frame ether_2 ether-type 2024 15.2 protocol-vlan vlan Description The protocol-vlan vlan command is used to create a Protocol-based VLAN entry. To delete a Protocol-based VLAN entry, please use no protocol-vlan vlan command. Syntax protocol-vlan vlan vlan-id priority priority template template-idx no protocol-vlan vlan group-idx Parameter vlan-id —— Specify IEEE 802.1Q VLAN ID, ranging from 1-4094. priority—— Specify the 802.1p priority for the packets that belong to the protocol VLAN, ranging from 0-7. The switch will determine the forwarding sequence according this value. The packets with larger value of 802.1p priority have the higher priority. template-idx ——The number of the Protocol-based VLAN Template. You can get the template corresponding to the number by the show protocol-vlan template command. group-idx ——The number of the Protocol-based VLAN entry. You can get the Protocol-based VLAN entry corresponding to the number by the show protocol-vlan vlan command. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 105 Example Create Protocol-based VLAN 2 and bind it with Protocol-based VLAN Template 3: T1600G-28TS(config)#protocol-vlan vlan 2 template 3 15.3 protocol-vlan group Description The protocol-vlan command is used to add the port to a specified protocol group. To remove the port from this protocol group, please use no protocol-vlan group command. Syntax protocol-vlan group index no protocol-vlan group index Parameter index —— Specify the protocol group ID. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Add Gigabit Ethernet port 20 to protocol group 1: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/20 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#protocol-vlan group 1 15.4 show protocol-vlan template Description The show protocol-vlan template command is used to display the information of the Protocol-based VLAN templates. 106 Syntax show protocol-vlan template Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the information of the Protocol-based VLAN templates: T1600G-28TS(config)#show protocol-vlan template 15.5 show protocol-vlan vlan Description The show protocol-vlan vlan command is used to display the information about Protocol-based VLAN entry. Syntax show protocol-vlan vlan Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display information of the Protocol-based VLAN entry: T1600G-28TS(config)#show protocol-vlan vlan 107 Chapter 16 GVRP Commands GVRP (GARP VLAN registration protocol) is an implementation of GARP (generic attribute registration protocol). GVRP allows the switch to automatically add or remove the VLANs via the dynamic VLAN registration information and propagate the local VLAN registration information to other switches, without having to individually configure each VLAN. 16.1 gvrp Description The gvrp command is used to enable the GVRP function globally. To disable the GVRP function, please use no gvrp command. Syntax gvrp no gvrp Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the GVRP function globally: T1600G-28TS(config)#gvrp 16.2 gvrp (interface) Description The gvrp command is used to enable the GVRP function for the desired port. To disable it, please use no gvrp command. The GVRP feature can only be enabled for the trunk-type ports. Syntax gvrp 108 no gvrp Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the GVRP function for Gigabit Ethernet ports 1/0/2-6: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-6 T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#gvrp 16.3 gvrp registration Description The gvrp registration command is used to configure the GVRP registration type for the desired port. To restore to the default value, please use no gvrp registration command. Syntax gvrp registration { normal | fixed | forbidden } no gvrp registration Parameter normal | fixed | forbidden —— Registration mode. By default, the registration mode is “normal”. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 109 Example Configure the GVRP registration mode as “fixed” for Gigabit Ethernet ports 1/0/2-6: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-6 T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#gvrp registration fixed 16.4 gvrp timer Description The gvrp timer command is used to set a GVRP timer for the desired port. To restore to the default setting of a GARP timer, please use no gvrp timer command. Syntax gvrp timer { leaveall | join | leave } value no gvrp timer [leaveall | join | leave] Parameter leaveall | join | leave —— They are the three timers: leave All, join and leave. Once the LeaveAll Timer is set, the port with GVRP enabled can send a LeaveAll message after the timer times out, so that other GARP ports can re-register all the attribute information. After that, the LeaveAll timer will start to begin a new cycle. To guarantee the transmission of the Join messages, a GARP port sends each Join message two times. The Join Timer is used to define the interval between the two sending operations of each Join message. Once the Leave Timer is set, the GARP port receiving a Leave message will start its Leave timer, and deregister the attribute information if it does not receive a Join message again before the timer times out. value ——The value of the timer. The LeaveAll Timer ranges from 1000 to 30000 centiseconds and the default value is 1000 centiseconds. The Join Timer ranges from 20 to 1000 centiseconds and the default value is 20 centiseconds. The Leave Timer ranges from 60 to 3000 centiseconds and the default value is 60 centiseconds. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) 110 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Set the GARP leaveall timer of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/6 as 2000 centiseconds and restore the join timer of it to the default value: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/6 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#gvrp timer leaveall 2000 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#no gvrp timer join 16.5 show gvrp interface Description The show gvrp interface command is used to display the GVRP configuration information of a specified Ethernet port or of all Ethernet ports. Syntax show gvrp interface [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] Parameter port —— The port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the GVRP configuration information of Gigabit Ethernet port 1: T1600G-28TS(config)#show gvrp interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 Display the GVRP configuration information of all Ethernet ports: T1600G-28TS(config)#show gvrp interface 111 16.6 show gvrp global Description The show gvrp global command is used to display the global GVRP status. Syntax show gvrp global Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the global GVRP status: T1600G-28TS(config)#show gvrp global 112 Chapter 17 IGMP Snooping Commands IGMP Snooping (Internet Group Management Protocol Snooping) is a multicast control mechanism running on Layer 2 switch. It can effectively prevent multicast groups being broadcasted in the network. 17.1 ip igmp snooping (global) Description The ip igmp snooping command is used to configure IGMP Snooping globally. To disable the IGMP Snooping function, please use no ip igmp Syntax snooping command. ip igmp snooping no ip igmp snooping Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable IGMP Snooping function: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping 17.2 ip igmp snooping version Description The ip igmp snooping version command is used to configure IGMP version globally. To return to the default configuration, please use no ip igmp Syntax snooping version command. ip igmp snooping version {v1 | v2 | v3 } no ip igmp snooping version 113 Parameter v1 | v2 | v3—— Specify the IGMP version. By default, it is IGMP v3. v1: The switch works as an IGMPv1 Snooping switch. It can only process IGMPv1 messages from the host. Report messages of other versions are ignored. v2: The switch works as an IGMPv2 Snooping switch. It can process both IGMPv1 and IGMPv2 messages from the host. IGMPv3 messages are ignored. v3: The switch works as an IGMPv3 Snooping switch. It can process IGMPv1, IGMPv2 and IGMPv3 messages from the host. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the IGMP version as v2: T1600G-28TS (config)# ip igmp snooping version v2 17.3 ip igmp snooping drop-unknown Description Syntax The ip igmp snooping drop-unknown command is used to configure the way how the switch processes multicast streams that are sent to unknown multicast groups as Discard. By default, it is Forward. To return to the default configuration, please use no ip igmp snooping drop-unknown command. ip igmp snooping drop-unknown no ip igmp snooping drop-unknown Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the operation to process unknown multicast as discard: 114 T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping drop-unknown 17.4 ip igmp snooping header-validation Description The ip igmp snooping header-validation command is used to enable IGMP Header Validation globally. To disable the IGMP Header Validation function, please use no ip igmp snooping header-validation command. Syntax Generally, for IGMP packets, the TTL value should be 1, ToS field should be 0xC0, and Router Alert option should be 0x94040000. The fields to be validated depend on the IGMP version being used. IGMPv1 only checks the TTL field. IGMPv2 checks the TTL field and the Router Alert option. IGMPv3 checks TTL field, ToS field and Router Alert option. Packets that fail the validation process will be dropped. ip igmp snooping header-validation no ip igmp snooping header-validation Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable IGMP Header Validation: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping header-validation 17.5 ip igmp snooping vlan-config Description The ip igmp snooping vlan-config command is used to enable VLAN IGMP Snooping function or to modify IGMP Snooping parameters. To disable the VLAN IGMP Snooping function, please use no ip igmp snooping vlan-config command. To restore the default values, please use no ip igmp snooping Syntax vlan-config with specified parameters. ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list [ rtime router-time | mtime member-time | ltime leave-time ] 115 no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list [ rtime | mtime | ltime ] Parameter vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration, ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5. router-time —— The Router Port Aging Time. Within this time, if the switch does not receive IGMP query message from the router port, it will consider this port is not a router port any more. Valid values are from 60 to 600 in seconds, and the default value is 300 seconds. member-time —— The Member Port Aging Time. Within this time, if the switch does not receive IGMP report message from the member port, it will consider this port is not a member port any more. Valid values are from 60 to 600 in seconds, and the default value is 260 seconds. leave-time —— The Leave Time. Valid values are from 1 to 30 in seconds, and the default value is 1 second. When the switch receives a leave message from a port to leave a multicast group, it will wait for a Leave Time before removing the port from the multicast group. During the period, if the switch receives any report messages from the port, the port will not be removed from the multicast group. Exceptions are as follows: If the member port ages out before the Leave Time ends and no report messages are received, the port will be removed from the multicast group once its Member Port Aging Time ends. The Leave Time mechanism will not take effect when Fast Leave takes effect. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the IGMP Snooping function and modify Router Port Aging Time as 300 seconds, Member Port Aging Time as 200 seconds for VLAN 1-3: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 1-3 rtime 300 T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 1-3 mtime 200 116 17.6 ip igmp snooping vlan-config (immediate-leave) Description This command is used to enable the Fast Leave feature for specific VLANs. To disable Fast Leave on the VLANs, please use no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list immediate-leave command. This function is disabled Syntax by default. ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list immediate-leave no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list immediate-leave Parameter vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration, ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the Fast Leave for VLAN 1-3: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 1-3 immediate-leave 17.7 ip igmp snooping vlan-config (report-suppression) Description This command is used to enable the IGMP Report Suppression function for specific VLANs. When enabled, the switch will only forward the first IGMP report message for each multicast group to the IGMP querier and suppress subsequent IGMP report messages for the same multicast group during one query interval. This feature prevents duplicate report messages from being sent to the IGMP querier. To disable the IGMP report suppression function and forward all the IGMP reports to the Layer 3 device in specific VLANs, 117 please use no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list report-suppression Syntax command. This function is disabled by default. ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list report-suppression no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list report-suppression Parameter vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration, ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the IGMP Report Suppression for VLAN 1-3: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 1-3 report-suppression 17.8 ip igmp snooping vlan-config (router-ports-forbidden) Description This command is used to forbid the specified ports as being router ports in the specified VLAN(s). To delete the forbidden router ports, please use no ip Syntax igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list router-ports-forbidd command. ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list router-ports-forbidd interface { gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list } no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list router-ports-forbidd interface [ gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list ] Parameter vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration, ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5. 118 port-list —— Forbid the specified ports as being router ports. Packets sent from multicast routers to these ports will be discarded. port-channel-list —— Forbid the specified port-channels as being router ports. Packets sent from multicast routers to these port-channels will be discarded. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Forbid the Ethernet ports 1/0/1-3 as being router ports in VLAN 1 : T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 1 router-ports-forbidd interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-3 17.9 ip igmp snooping vlan-config (rport interface) Description This command is used to specify the static router ports for specific VLANs. To delete the static router ports, please use no ip igmp snooping Syntax vlan-config vlan-id-list rport interface command. ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list rport interface { gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list } no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list { gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list } Parameter rport interface vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration, ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5. port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports. port-channel-list—— The ID of the port channels. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement 119 Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Set the router port as 1/0/1 for VLAN 1-2: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 1-2 rport interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 17.10 ip igmp snooping vlan-config (static) Description This command is used to configure interfaces to statically join a multicast group. To remove interfaces from a static multicast group, please use no ip Syntax igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list staticcommand. ip igmp no ip snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list static { gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list } igmp snooping vlan-config ip interface vlan-id-list static ip interface { gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list } Parameter vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration, ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5. ip ——Specify the IP address of the multicast group that the hosts want to join. port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports. port-channel-list —— The ID of the port channels. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure port ports 1/0/1-3 in VLAN 2 to statically join multicast group 225.0.0.1: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 2 static 225.0.0.1 interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-3 120 17.11 ip igmp snooping vlan-config (querier) Description This command is used to enable the IGMP Snooping Querier feature for specific VLANs. To disable the IGMP Snooping Querier feature on the VLANs, please use no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list querier command without any parameters. To restore the default values, please use no ip igmp snooping Syntax parameters. vlan-config vlan-id-list querier command with specified ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list querier [ max-response-time response-time | query-interval interval | general-query source-ip ip-addr | last-member-query-count count | last-member-query-interval interval ] no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list querier [ max-response-time | query-interval | general-query source-ip | last-member-query-count ] Parameter vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration, ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5. response-time—— The host’s maximum response time to general query messages. Valid values are from 1 to 25 seconds, and the default value is 10 seconds. query-interval interval—— The interval between general query messages sent by the switch. Valid values are from 10 to 300 seconds, and the default value is 60 seconds. ip-addr—— The source IP address of the general query messages sent by the switch. It should be a unicast address. By default, it is 0.0.0.0. count —— The number of group-specific queries to be sent. With IGMP Snooping Querier enabled, when the switch receives an IGMP leave message, it obtains the address of the multicast group that the host wants to leave from the message. Then the switch sends out group-specific queries to this multicast group through the port receiving the leave message. If specified count of group-specific queries are sent and no report message is received, the switch will delete the multicast address from the multicast forwarding table. Valid values are from 1 to 5, and the default value is 2. last-member-query-interval interval —— The interval between groupspecific queries.. Valid values are from 1 to 5 seconds, and the default value is 1 second. 121 Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the IGMP Snooping Querier for VLAN 3, and configure the query interval as 100 seconds: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 3 querier T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 3 querier query interval 100 17.12 ip igmp snooping (interface) Description The ip igmp snooping command is used to enable the IGMP Snooping function for the desired port. To disable the IGMP Snooping function, please Syntax use no ip igmp snooping command. ip igmp snooping no ip igmp snooping Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable IGMP Snooping function of port 1/0/3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip igmp snooping 122 17.13 ip igmp snooping max-groups Description The ip igmp snooping max-groups command is used to configure the maximum number of groups that a port can join in. The ip igmp snooping max-groups action is used to configure the action that the port takes when it receives an IGMP report message and the maximum number of entries is in the forwarding table. To remove the maximum group limitation and return to the default of no limitation on the specified port, please use the no ip igmp snooping max-groups command. To return to the default action of dropping the report, please use the no ip igmp snooping max-groups action Syntax command. These commands only apply to the dynamic multicast groups. ip igmp snooping max-groups maxgroup ip igmp snooping max-groups action { drop | replace } no ip igmp snooping max-groups no ip igmp snooping max-groups action Parameter maxgroup —— Specify the maximum numbers of groups that the port can join. It ranges from 0 to 1000 and the default value is 1000. drop —— When the number of the dynamic multicast groups that a port joins has exceeded the max-group, the port will not join any new multicast group. replace —— When the number of the dynamic multicast groups that a port joins has exceeded the max-group, the newly joined multicast group will replace an existing multicast group with the lowest multicast group address. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the maximum numbers of groups that ports 1/0/2-5 can join as 10, and configure the throttling action as replace: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-5 123 T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ip igmp snooping max-groups 10 T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ip igmp snooping max-groups action replace 17.14 ip igmp snooping immediate-leave Description The ip igmp snooping immediate-leave command is used to configure the Fast Leave function for port. To disable the Fast Leave function, please use Syntax no ip igmp snooping immediate-leave command. ip igmp snooping immediate-leave no ip igmp snooping immediate-leave Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the Fast Leave function for port 1/0/3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip igmp snooping immediate-leave 17.15 ip igmp profile Description The ip igmp profile command is used to create the configuration profile. To delete the corresponding profile, please use no ip igmp profile command. Syntax ip igmp profile id no ip igmp profile id 124 Parameter id —— Specify the id of the configuration profile, ranging from 1 to 999. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create the profile 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp profile 1 17.16 deny Description The deny command is used to configure the filtering mode of profile as deny. Syntax deny Command Mode Profile Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the filtering mode of profile 1 as deny: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp profile 1 T1600G-28TS(config-igmp-profile)#deny 17.17 permit Description The permit command is used to configure the filtering mode of profile as permit. 125 Syntax permit Command Mode Profile Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the filtering mode of profile 1 as permit: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp profile 1 T1600G-28TS(config-igmp-profile)#permit 17.18 range Description The range command is used to configure the range of the profile’s filtering multicast address. To delete the corresponding filtering multicast address, please use no range command. A profile contains 16 filtering IP-range entries at most. Syntax range start-ip end-ip no range start-ip end-ip Parameter start-ip —— The start filtering multicast IP address. end-ip —— The end filtering multicast IP address. Command Mode Profile Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 126 Example Configure one of the filter multicast address entry as range 225.1.1.1 to 226.3.2.1 in profile 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp profile 1 T1600G-28TS(config-igmp-profile)#range 225.1.1.1 226.3.2.1 17.19 ip igmp filter Description Syntax The ip igmp filter command is used to bind the specified profile to the interface. To delete the binding, please use no ip igmp filter command. ip igmp filter profile-id no ip igmp filter Parameter profile-id —— Specify the profile ID, ranging from 1 to 999. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Bind profile 1 to interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip igmp filter 1 17.20 clear ip igmp snooping statistics Description Syntax The clear ip igmp snooping statistics command is used to clear the statistics of the IGMP packets. clear ip igmp snooping statistics Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 127 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Clear the statistics of the IGMP packets: T1600G-28TS(config)# clear ip igmp snooping statistics 17.21 show ip igmp snooping Description The show ip igmp snooping command is used to display the global Syntax configuration of IGMP snooping. show ip igmp snooping Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the global configuration of IGMP: T1600G-28TS# show ip igmp snooping 17.22 show ip igmp snooping interface Description The show ip igmp snooping interface command is used to display the port configuration of IGMP snooping. If no interface is specified, it displays all Syntax interfaces’ IGMP snooping configurations. show ip igmp snooping interface [ gigabitEthernet [port-list ] | port-channel [ port-channel-list ] ] { basic-config | max-groups | packet-stat } Parameter port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports. Port-channel-list —— The list of port channels. 128 basic-config | max-groups | packet-stat —— The related configuration information selected to display. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the IGMP baisic configuration configuration of all ports and port channels: T1600G-28TS# show ip igmp snooping interface basic-config Display the IGMP basic configuration of port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS# show ip igmp snooping interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 basic-config Display the IGMP packet statistics of ports 1/0/1-4: T1600G-28TS# show ip igmp snooping interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-4 packet-stat 17.23 show ip igmp snooping vlan Description The show ip igmp snooping vlan command is used to display the VLAN Syntax configuration of IGMP snooping. show ip igmp snooping vlan [ vlan-id ] Parameter vlan-id ——The VLAN ID selected to display. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the IGMP snooping configuration information of VLAN 2: T1600G-28TS# show ip igmp snooping vlan 2 129 17.24 show ip igmp snooping groups Description The show ip igmp snooping groups command is used to display the information of all IGMP snooping groups. It can be extended to some other commands to display the dynamic and static multicast information of a Syntax selected VLAN. show ip igmp snooping groups [ vlan { vlan-id } ] [ multicast_addr | count | dynamic | dynamic count | static | static count ] Parameter vlan-id ——The VLAN ID selected to display the information of all multicast items. multicast_addr —— IP address of the multicast group. count—— The numbers of all multicast groups. dynamic—— Display dynamic multicast groups. dynamic count—— The numbers of all dynamic multicast groups. static—— Display static multicast groups. static count—— The numbers of all static multicast groups. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the information of all IGMP snooping groups: T1600G-28TS#show ip igmp snooping groups Display all the multicast entries in VLAN 5: T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip igmp snooping groups vlan 5 Display the count of multicast entries in VLAN 5: T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip igmp snooping groups vlan 5 count Display the dynamic multicast groups of VLAN 5 T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip igmp snooping groups vlan 5 dynamic Display the static multicast groups of VLAN 5 130 T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip igmp snooping groups vlan 5 static Display the count of dynamic multicast entries of VLAN 5 T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip igmp snooping groups vlan 5 dynamic count Display the count of static multicast entries of VLAN 5 T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip igmp snooping groups vlan 5 static count 17.25 show ip igmp profile Description The show ip igmp profile command is used to display the configuration information of all the profiles or a specific profile. Syntax show ip igmp profile [ id ] Parameter id —— Specify the ID of the profile, ranging from 1 to 999. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configuration information of all profiles: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip igmp profile 131 Chapter 18 MLD Snooping Commands MLD Snooping (Multicast Listener Discovery Snooping) is a multicast control mechanism running on Layer 2 switch. It can effectively prevent multicast groups being broadcasted in the IPv6 network. 18.1 ipv6 mld snooping (global) Description Syntax The ipv6 mld snooping command is used to enable MLD Snooping function globally. If this function is disabled, all related MLD Snooping function would not work. To disable this function, please use no ipv6 mld snooping command. ipv6 mld snooping no ipv6 mld snooping Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Enable MLD Snooping: T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping 18.2 ipv6 mld snooping drop-unknown Description Syntax The ipv6 mld snooping drop-unknown command is used to enable the unknown multicast packets filter function. To disable this function, please use no ipv6 mld snooping drop-unknown command. By default, it is disabled. ipv6 mld snooping drop-unknown no ipv6 mld snooping drop-unknown Command Mode Global Configuration Mode 132 Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Enable unknown multicast filter function: T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping drop-unknown 18.3 ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config Description The ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config command is used to enable VLAN MLD Snooping function or to modify MLD Snooping parameters. To disable the VLAN MLD Snooping function, please use no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config Syntax command. ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list [ rtime router-time | mtime member-time | ltime leave-time ] no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list [ rtime | mtime | ltime ] Parameter vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration, ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5. router-time —— The Router Port Aging Time. Within this time, if the switch does not receive any MLD query messages from the router port, it will consider this port is not a router port any more. Valid values are from 60 to 600 in seconds, and the default value is 300 seconds. member-time —— The Member Port Aging Time. Within this time, if the switch does not receive any MLD report messages from the member port, it will consider this port is not a member port any more. Valid values are from 60 to 600 in seconds, and the default value is 260 seconds. leave-time —— The Leave Time. Valid values are from 1 to 30 in seconds, and the default value is 1 second. When the switch receives a done message from a port to leave a multicast group, it will wait for a Leave Time before removing the port from the multicast group. During the period, if the switch receives any report messages from the port, the port will not be removed from the multicast group. Exceptions are as follows: If the member port ages out before the Leave Time ends and no report messages are received, the port will be removed from the multicast group once its Member Port Aging Time ends. 133 The Leave Time mechanism will not take effect when Fast Leave takes effect. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the MLD Snooping function and modify Router Port Time as 300 seconds, Member Port Time as 200 seconds for VLAN 1-3: T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 1-3 rtime 300 T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 1-3 mtime 200 18.4 ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (immediate-leave) Description This command is used to enable the Fast Leave feature for specific VLANs. To disable Fast Leave on the VLANs, please use no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list immediate-leave command. This function is disabled Syntax by default. ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list immediate-leave no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list immediate-leave Parameter vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration, ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the Fast Leave for VLAN 1-3: 134 T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 1-3 immediate-leave 18.5 ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (report-suppression) Description This command is used to enable the MLD Report Suppression function for specific VLANs. When enabled, the switch will only forward the first MLD report message for each multicast group to the MLD querier and suppress subsequent MLD report messages for the same multicast group during one query interval. This feature prevents duplicate report messages from being sent to the MLD querier. To disable the MLD report suppression function and forward all the MLD reports to the Layer 3 device in specific VLANs, please use no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list report-suppression Syntax command. This function is disabled by default. ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list report-suppression no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list report-suppression Parameter vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration, ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the MLD Report Suppression for VLAN 1-3: T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 1-3 report-suppression 135 18.6 ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (router-ports-forbidden) Description This command is used to forbid the specified ports as being router ports in the specified VLAN(s). To delete the forbidden router ports, please use no Syntax ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list router-ports-forbidd command. ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list router-ports-forbidd interface { gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list } no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list router-ports-forbidd interface [ gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list ] Parameter vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration, ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5. port-list —— Forbid the specified ports as being router ports. Packets sent from multicast routers to these ports will be discarded. port-channel-list —— Forbid the specified port-channels as being router ports. Packets sent from multicast routers to these port-channels will be discarded. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Forbid the Ethernet ports 1/0/1-3 as being router ports in VLAN 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 1 router-ports-forbidd interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-3 136 18.7 ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (rport interface) Description This command is used to specify the static router ports for specific VLANs. To delete the static router ports, please use no ipv6 mld snooping Syntax vlan-config vlan-id-list rport interface command. ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list rport interface { gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list } no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list { gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list } rport interface Parameter vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration, ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5. port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports. port-channel-list—— The ID of the port channels. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Set the router port as 1/0/1 for VLAN 1-2: T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 1-2 rport interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 18.8 ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (static) Description This command is used to configure interfaces to statically join a multicast group. To remove interfaces from a static multicast group, please use no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list staticcommand. 137 Syntax ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list static { gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list } ip interface no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list static ip interface { gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list } Parameter vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration, ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5. ip ——Specify the IP address of the multicast group that the hosts want to join. port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports. port-channel-list —— The ID of the port channels. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure port ports 1/0/1-3 in VLAN 2 to statically join multicast group 225.0.0.1: T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 2 static 225.0.0.1 interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-3 18.9 ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (querier) Description This command is used to enable the MLD Snooping Querier feature for specific VLANs. To disable the MLD Snooping Querier feature on the VLANs, please use no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list querier command without any parameters. To restore the default values, please use no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list querier command with specified parameters. 138 Syntax ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list querier [ max-response-time response-time | query-interval interval | general-query source-ip ip-addr | last-listener-query-count count | last-listener-query-interval interval ] no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list querier [ max-response-time | query-interval | general-query source-ip | last-listener-query-count | last-listener-query-interval ] Parameter vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration, ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5. response-time—— The host’s maximum response time to general query messages. Valid values are from 1 to 25 seconds, and the default value is 10 seconds. query-interval interval—— The interval between general query messages sent by the switch. Valid values are from 10 to 300 seconds, and the default value is 60 seconds. ip-addr—— The source IP address of the general query messages sent by the switch. It should be a unicast address. By default, it is fe80::2ff:ffff:fe00:1. count —— The number of group-specific queries to be sent. With MLD Snooping Querier enabled, when the switch receives an MLD done message, it obtains the address of the multicast group that the host wants to leave from the message. Then the switch sends out group-specific queries to this multicast group through the port receiving the done message. If specified count of group-specific queries are sent and no report message is received, the switch will delete the multicast address from the multicast forwarding table. Valid values are from 1 to 5, and the default value is 2. last-member-query-interval interval —— The interval between groupspecific queries. Valid values are from 1 to 5 seconds, and the default value is 1 second. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 139 Example Enable the MLD Snooping Querier for VLAN 3, and configure the query interval as 100 seconds: T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 3 querier T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 3 querier query interval 100 18.10 ipv6 mld snooping (interface) Description Syntax The ipv6 mld snooping command is used to enable MLD Snooping function on the desired port. To disable this function, please use no ipv6 mld snooping command. ipv6 mld snooping no ipv6 mld snooping Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Enable MLD Snooping on port 1/0/3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 mld snooping 18.11 ipv6 mld snooping max-groups Description The ipv6 mld snooping max-groups command is used to configure the maximum number of groups that a port can join in. The ipv6 mld snooping max-groups action is used to configure the action that the port takes when it receives an MLD report message and the maximum number of entries is in the forwarding table. To remove the maximum group limitation and return to the default of no limitation on the specified port, please use the no ipv6 mld 140 snooping max-groups command. To return to the default action of dropping the report, please use the no ipv6 mld snooping max-groups action Syntax command. These commands only apply to the dynamic multicast groups. ipv6 mld snooping max-groups maxgroup ipv6 mld snooping max-groups action { drop | replace } no ipv6 mld snooping max-groups no ipv6 mld snooping max-groups action Parameter maxgroup —— Specify the maximum numbers of groups that the port can join. It ranges from 0 to 1000 and the default value is 1000. drop —— When the number of the dynamic multicast groups that a port joins has exceeded the max-group, the port will not join any new multicast group. replace —— When the number of the dynamic multicast groups that a port joins has exceeded the max-group, the newly joined multicast group will replace an existing multicast group with the lowest multicast group address. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the maximum numbers of groups that ports 1/0/2-5 can join as 10, and configure the throttling action as replace: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-5 T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ipv6 mld snooping max-groups 10 T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ipv6 mld snooping max-groups action replace 18.12 ipv6 mld snooping immediate-leave Description The ipv6 mld snooping immediate-leave command is used to configure the Fast Leave function for port. To disable the Fast Leave function, please use no ipv6 mld snooping immediate-leave command. 141 Syntax ipv6 mld snooping immediate-leave no ipv6 mld snooping immediate-leave Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the Fast Leave function for port 1/0/3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 mld snooping immediate-leave 18.13 ipv6 mld profile Description The ipv6 mld profile command is used to create the configuration profile. To delete the corresponding profile, please use no ipv6 mld profile command. Syntax ipv6 mld profile id no ipv6 mld profile id Parameter id —— Specify the id of the configuration profile, ranging from 1 to 999. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Create the profile 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld profile 1 142 18.14 deny Description The deny command is used to configure the filtering mode of profile as deny. Syntax deny Command Mode Profile Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the filtering mode of profile 1 as deny: T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld profile 1 T1600G-28TS(config-MLD-profile)#deny 18.15 permit Description The permit command is used to configure the filtering mode of profile as permit. Syntax permit Command Mode Profile Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the filtering mode of profile 1 as permit: T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld profile 1 T1600G-28TS(config-igmp-profile)#permit 143 18.16 range Description The range command is used to configure the range of the profile’s filtering multicast address. To delete the corresponding filtering multicast address, please use no range command. A profile contains 16 filtering IP-range entries at most. Syntax range start-ip end-ip no range start-ip end-ip Parameter start-ip —— Start IPv6 multicast address of the filter entry.. end-ip —— End IPv6 multicast address of the filter entry. Command Mode Profile Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure one of the filter multicast address entry as range ff80::1234 to ff80::1235 in profile 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld profile 1 T1600G-28TS(config-igmp-profile)#range ff80::1234 ff80::1235 18.17 ipv6 mld filter Description Syntax The ipv6 mld filter command is used to bind the specified profile to the interface. To delete the binding, please use no ipv6 mld filter command. ipv6 mld filter profile-id no ipv6 mld filter Parameter profile-id —— Specify the profile ID, ranging from 1 to 999. 144 Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Bind profile 1 to interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 mld filter 1 18.18 clear ipv6 mld snooping statistics Description Syntax The clear ipv6 mld snooping statistics command is used to clear the statistics of the MLD packets. clear ipv6 mld snooping statistics Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Clear the statistics of the MLD packets: T1600G-28TS(config)# clear ipv6 mld snooping statistics 18.19 show ipv6 mld snooping Description Syntax The show ipv6 mld snooping command is used to display the global configuration of MLD Snooping. show ipv6 mld snooping Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 145 Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the global configuration of MLD Snooping: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 mld snooping 18.20 show ipv6 mld snooping interface Description The show ipv6 mld snooping interface command is used to display the port Syntax configuration of MLD snooping. show ipv6 mld snooping interface [ gigabitEthernet [ port | port-list ] ] { basic-config | max-groups | packet-stat } show ipv6 mld snooping interface [ port-channel [ port-channel-list ] ] { basic-config | max-groups } Parameter port —— The Ethernet port number. port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports. basic-config | max-groups | packet-stat —— The related configuration information selected to display. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the MLD baisic configuration configuration of all ports and port channels: T1600G-28TS# show ipv6 mld snooping interface basic-config Display the MLD basic configuration of port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS# show ipv6 mld snooping interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 basic-config 146 Display the MLD packet statistics of ports 1/0/1-4: T1600G-28TS# show ipv6 mld snooping interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-4 packet-stat 18.21 show ipv6 mld snooping vlan Description Syntax The show ipv6 mld snooping vlan command is used to display VLAN information of MLD Snooping. show ipv6 mld snooping vlan [ vlan-id ] Parameter vlan-id —— The VLAN ID selected to display, ranging from 1 to 4094. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display all of the VLAN information: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 mld snooping vlan 18.22 show ipv6 mld snooping groups Description Syntax The show ipv6 mld snooping groups command is used to display multicast groups. show ipv6 mld snooping groups [ vlan { vlan-id } ] [ ipv6_multicast_addr | count | dynamic | dynamic count | static | static count ] Parameter vlan-id ——The VLAN ID selected to display the information of all multicast items. ipv6_multicast_addr —— IPv6 address of the multicast group. count—— The numbers of all multicast groups. dynamic—— Display dynamic multicast groups. 147 dynamic count—— The numbers of all dynamic multicast groups. static—— Display static multicast groups. static count—— The numbers of all static multicast groups. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display all of the multicast groups: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 mld snooping groups 18.23 show ipv6 mld profile Description The show ipv6 mld profile command is used to display the configuration information of all the profiles or a specific profile. Syntax show ipv6 mld profile [ id ] Parameter id —— Specify the ID of the profile, ranging from 1 to 999. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configuration information of all profiles: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 mld profile 148 Chapter 19 MVR Commands MVR (Multicast VLAN Registration) allows a single multicast VLAN to be shared for multicast member ports in different VLANs in IPv4 network. In IGMP Snooping, if member ports are in different VLANs, a copy of the multicast streams is sent to each VLAN that has member ports. While MVR provides a dedicated multicast VLAN to forward multicast traffic over the Layer 2 network, to avoid duplication of multicast streams for clients in different VLANs. Clients can dynamically join or leave the multicast VLAN without interfering with their relationships in other VLANs. 19.1 mvr (global) Description The mvr command is used to enable MVR globally. To disable MVR, please use no mvr command. Syntax mvr no mvr Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable MVR globally: T1600G-28TS(config)# mvr 19.2 mvr group Description The mvr group command is used to add multicast groups to MVR. To delete multicast groups from MVR, please use no mvr group command. Syntax mvr group ip-addr [count ] 149 no mvr group ip-addr [count ] Parameter ip-addr —— The start IP address of the contiguous series of multicast groups. count —— The number of the multicast groups to be added to the MVR. Valid values are from 1 to 256, and the default value is 1. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Add multicast groups 225.1.2.3 -239.1.2.5 to MVR: T1600G-28TS (config)# mvr group 225.1.2.3 3 19.3 mvr mode Description Syntax The mvr mode command is used to configure the MVR mode as compatible or dynamic. By default, it is compatible. To return to the default configuration, please use no mvr mode command. mvr mode { compatible | dynamic } no mvr mode Parameter compatible —— In this mode, the switch does not forward report or leave messages from the hosts to the IGMP querier. So the IGMP querier cannot learn the multicast groups membership information from the switch. You have to statically configure the IGMP querier to transmit all the required multicast streams to the switch via the multicast VLAN. dynamic —— In this mode, after receiving report or leave messages from the hosts, the switch will forward them to the IGMP querier via the multicast VLAN (with appropriate translation of the VLAN ID). So the IGMP querier can learn the multicast groups membership information through the report and leave messages, and transmit the multicast streams to the switch via the multicast VLAN according to the multicast forwarding table. 150 Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the MVR mode as dynamic: T1600G-28TS(config)# mvr mode dynamic 19.4 mvr querytime Description The mvr querytime command is used to configure the maximum time to wait for IGMP report on a receiver port before removing the port from multicast group membership. To return to the default configuration, please use no mvr querytime command. Syntax mvr querytime time no mvr querytime Parameter time —— The query response time. Valid values are from 1 to100 tenths of a second, and the default value is 5 tenths of a second. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the query response time of MVR as 1 second, that is 10 tenths of a second: T1600G-28TS(config)# mvr querytime 10 151 19.5 mvr vlan Description The mvr vlan command is used to specify the multicast VLAN. By default, it is VLAN 1. To return to the default configuration, please use no mvr vlan command. Syntax mvr vlan vlan-id no mvr vlan Parameter vlan-id —— The ID of the multicast VLAN. Valid values are from 1 to 4094. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the multicast VLAN as VLAN 10: T1600G-28TS(config)# mvr vlan 10 19.6 mvr (interface) Description This command is used to enable MVR for specific interfaces. To disable MVR for the interfaces, please use no mvr command. By default, it is disabled. Syntax mvr no mvr Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 152 Example Enable MVR for port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#mvr 19.7 mvr type Description The mvr type command is used to configure the MVR port type as receiver or source. By default, the port is a non-MVR port. If you attempt to configure a non-MVR port with MVR characteristics, the operation fails. To return to the default configuration, please use no mvr type command. Syntax mvr type { source | receiver } no mvr type Parameter source —— Configure the uplink ports that receive and send multicast data on the multicast VLAN as source ports. Source ports should belong to the multicast VLAN. receiver —— Configure the ports that are connecting to the hosts as receiver ports. A receiver port can only belong to one VLAN, and cannot belong to the multicast VLAN. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the port 1/0/3 as a receiver port: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#mvr type receiver 153 19.8 mvr immediate Description The mvr immediate command is used to enable the Fast Leave feature of MVR for specified port. To disable the Fast Leave feature of MVR for specific ports, please use no mvr immediate command. Syntax mvr immediate no mvr immediate Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. User Guidelines Only receiver ports support Fast Leave. Before enabling Fast Leave for a port, make sure there is only a single receiver device connecting to the port. Example Enable the Fast Leave feature of MVR for port 1/0/3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#mvr immediate 19.9 mvr vlan (group) Description This command is used to statically add ports to an MVR group. Then the ports can receive multicast traffic sent to the IP multicast address via the multicast VLAN. Syntax mvr vlan vlan-id group ip-addr Parameter vlan-id —— The ID of the multicast VLAN. Valid values are from 1 to 4094. ip-addr —— The IP address of the multicast group. 154 Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. User Guidelines This command applies to only receiver ports. The switch adds or removes the receiver ports to the corresponding multicast groups by snooping the report and leave messages from the hosts. You can also statically add a receiver port to an MVR group. Example Add port 1/0/3 to MVR group 225.1.2.3 statically. The multicast VLAN is VLAN 10: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#mvr vlan 10 group 225.1.2.3 19.10 show mvr Description The show mvr command is used to display the global configuration of MVR. Syntax show mvr Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the global configuration of mvr: T1600G-28TS# show mvr 155 19.11 show mvr interface Description The show mvr interface command is used to display the MVR configurations of specific interfaces. Syntax show mvr interface gigabitEthernet [port | port-list ] Parameter port ——The Ethernet port number. port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the MVR configuration of port 1/0/3: T1600G-28TS# show mvr interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 19.12 show mvr members Description The show mvr members command is used to display the membership information of all MVR groups or the specified MVR group. Syntax show mvr members [ ip-addr ] Parameter ip-addr——The multicast IP address of the MVR group. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the membership information of all MVR groups: 156 T1600G-28TS# show mvr members 19.13 show mvr traffic Description The show mvr traffic command is used to display the statistics information of all MVR groups. Syntax show mvr traffic Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the statistics information of all MVR groups: T1600G-28TS# show mvr traffic 157 Chapter 20 MSTP Commands MSTP (Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol), compatible with both STP and RSTP and subject to IEEE 802.1s, can disbranch a ring network. STP is to block redundant links and backup links as well as optimize paths. 20.1 debug spanning-tree Description The debug spanning-tree command is used to enable debuggning of spanning-tree activities. To disable the debugging function, please use no Syntax debug spanning-tree command. debug spanning-tree { all | bpdu receive | bpdu transmit | cmpmsg | errors | flush | init | migration | proposals | roles | state | tc } no debug spanning-tree { all | bpdu receive | bpdu transmit | cmpmsg | errors | flush | init | migration | proposals | roles | state | tc } Parameters all —— Display all the spanning-tree debug messages. bpdu receive —— Display the debug messages of the received spanning-tree bridge protocol data unit (BPDU). bpdu transmit —— Display the debug messages of the sent spanning-tree BPDU. cmpmsg —— Display the message priority debug messages. errors —— Display the MSTP error debug messages. flush —— Display the address table flushing debug messages. init —— Display the data structure initialization debug messages. migration —— Display the version migration debug messages. proposals —— Display the MSTP handshake debug messages. roles —— Display the MSTP interface role switchling debug messages. state —— Display the MSTP interface state change debug messages. tc —— Display the MSTP topology event debug messages. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode 158 Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display all the spanning-tree debug messages: T1600G-28TS# debug spanning-tree all 20.2 spanning-tree (global) Description The spanning-tree command is used to enable STP function globally. To Syntax disable the STP function, please use no spanning-tree command. spanning-tree no spanning-tree Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the STP function: T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree 20.3 spanning-tree (interface) Description The spanning-tree command is used to enable STP function for a port. To Syntax disable the STP function, please use no spanning-tree command. spanning-tree no spanning-tree Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) 159 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the STP function for port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree 20.4 spanning-tree common-config Description The spanning-tree common-config command is used to configure the parameters of the ports for comparison in the CIST and the common parameters of all instances. To return to the default configuration, please use no spanning-tree common-config command. CIST (Common and Internal Spanning Tree) is the spanning tree in a switched network, connecting all Syntax devices in the network. spanning-tree common-config [ port-priority pri ] [ ext-cost ext-cost ] [ int-cost int-cost ] [ portfast { enable | disable }] [ point-to-point { auto | open | close }] no spanning-tree common-config Parameter pri —— Port Priority, which must be multiple of 16 ranging from 0 to 240. By default, the port priority is 128. Port Priority is an important criterion on determining if the port connected to this port will be chosen as the root port. In the same condition, the port with the highest priority will be chosen as the root port. The lower value has the higher priority. ext-cost —— External Path Cost, which is used to choose the path and calculate the path costs of ports in different MST regions. It is an important criterion on determining the root port. The lower value has the higher priority. It ranges from o to 2000000. By default, it is 0 which is mean auto. int-cost —— Internal Path Cost, which is used to choose the path and calculate the path costs of ports in an MST region. It is an important criterion on determining the root port. The lower value has the higher priority. By 160 default, it is automatic. It ranges from o to 2000000. By default, it is 0 which is mean auto. portfast —— Enable/ Disable Edge Port. By default, it is disabled. The edge port can transit its state from blocking to forwarding rapidly without waiting for forward delay. point-to-point —— The P2P link status, with auto, open and close options. By default, the option is auto. If the two ports in the P2P link are root port or designated port, they can transit their states to forwarding rapidly to reduce the unnecessary forward delay. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the STP function of port 1, and configure the Port Priority as 64, ExtPath Cost as 100, IntPath Cost as 100, and then enable Edge Port: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree common-config port-priority 64 ext-cost 100 int-cost 100 portfast enable point-to-point open 20.5 spanning-tree mode Description The spanning-tree mode command is used to configure the STP mode of the switch. To return to the default configurations, please use no spanning-tree Syntax mode command. spanning-tree mode { stp | rstp | mstp } no spanning-tree mode Parameter stp ——Spanning Tree Protocol, the default value. rstp ——Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol mstp ——Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol 161 Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the spanning-tree mode as mstp: T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mode mstp 20.6 spanning-tree mst configuration Description The spanning-tree mst configuration command is used to access MST Configuration Mode from Global Configuration Mode, as to configure the VLAN-Instance mapping, region name and revision level. To return to the default configuration of the corresponding Instance, please use no Syntax spanning-tree mst configuration command. spanning-tree mst configuration no spanning-tree mst configuration Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enter into the MST configuration mode: T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mst configuration T1600G-28TS(Config-mst)# 20.7 instance Description The instance command is used to configure the VLAN-Instance mapping. To remove the VLAN-instance mapping or disable the corresponding instance, 162 please use no instance command. When an instance is disabled, the related Syntax mapping VLANs will be removed. instance instance-id vlan vlan-id no instance instance-id [ vlan vlan-id ] Parameters instance-id —— Instance ID, ranging from 1 to 8. vlan-id —— The VLAN ID selected to mapping with the corresponding instance. Command Mode MST Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Map the VLANs 1-100 to Instance 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mst configuration T1600G-28TS(config-mst)# instance 1 vlan 1-100 Disable Instance 1, namely remove all the mapping VLANs 1-100: T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mst configuration T1600G-28TS(config-mst)# no instance 1 Remove VLANs 1-50 in mapping VLANs 1-100 for Instance 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mst configuration T1600G-28TS(config-mst)# no instance 1 vlan 1-50 20.8 name Description Syntax The name command is used to configure the region name of MST instance. name name 163 Parameters name —— The region name, used to identify MST region. It ranges from 1 to 32 characters. Command Mode MST Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the region name of MST as “region1”: T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mst configuration T1600G-28TS(config-mst)# name region1 20.9 revision Description The revision command is used to configure the revision level of MST Syntax instance. revision revision Parameters revision —— The revision level for MST region identification, ranging from 0 to 65535. Command Mode MST Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the revision level of MST as 100: T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mst configuration T1600G-28TS(config-mst)# revision 100 164 20.10 spanning-tree mst instance Description The spanning-tree mst instance command is used to configure the priority of MST instance. To return to the default value of MST instance priority, Syntax please use no spanning-tree mst instance command. spanning-tree mst instance instance-id priority pri no spanning-tree mst instance instance-id priority Parameter instance-id —— Instance ID, ranging from 1 to 8. pri —— MSTI Priority, which must be multiple of 4096 ranging from 0 to 61440. By default, it is 32768. MSTI priority is an important criterion on determining if the switch will be chosen as the root bridge in the specific instance. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the MST Instance 1 and configure its priority as 4096: T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mst instance 1 priority 4096 20.11 spanning-tree mst Description The spanning-tree mst command is used to configure MST Instance Port. To return to the default configuration of the corresponding Instance Port, please use no spanning-tree mst command. A port can play different roles in different spanning tree instance. You can use this command to configure the parameters of the ports in different instance IDs as well as view status of the Syntax ports in the specified instance. spanning-tree mst instance instance-id {[ port-priority pri ] | [ cost cost ]} 165 no spanning-tree mst instance instance-id Parameter instance-id —— Instance ID, ranging from 1 to 8. pri —— Port Priority, which must be multiple of 16 ranging from 0 to 240. By default, it is 128. Port Priority is an important criterion on determining if the port will be chosen as the root port by the device connected to this port. cost —— Path Cost, ranging from 0 to 200000. The lower value has the higher priority. Its default value is 0 meaning “auto”. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the priority of port 1 in MST Instance 1 as 64, and path cost as 2000: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree mst instance 1 port-priority 64 cost 2000 20.12 spanning-tree priority Description The spanning-tree priority command is used to configure the bridge priority. To return to the default value of bridge priority, please use no spanning-tree Syntax priority command. spanning-tree priority pri no spanning-tree priority Parameter pri —— Bridge priority, ranging from 0 to 61440. It is 32768 by default. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode 166 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the bridge priority as 4096: T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree priority 4096 20.13 spanning-tree timer Description The spanning-tree timer command is used to configure forward-time, hello-time and max-age of Spanning Tree. To return to the default Syntax configurations, please use no spanning-tree timer command. spanning-tree timer {[ forward-time forward-time ] [ hello-time hello-time ] [ max-age max-age ]} no spanning-tree timer Parameter forward-time —— Forward Delay, which is the time for the port to transit its state after the network topology is changed. Forward Delay ranges from 4 to 30 in seconds and it is 15 by default. Otherwise, 2 * (Forward Delay - 1) >= Max Age. hello-time ——Hello Time, which is the interval to send BPDU packets, and used to test the links. Hello Time ranges from 1 to 10 in seconds and it is 2 by default. Otherwise, 2 * (Hello Time + 1) <= Max Age. max-age —— The maximum time the switch can wait without receiving a BPDU before attempting to reconfigure, ranging from 6 to 40 in seconds. By default, it is 20. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure forward-time, hello-time and max-age for Spanning Tree as 16 seconds, 3 seconds and 22 seconds respectively: 167 T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree timer forward-time 16 hello-time 3 max-age 22 20.14 spanning-tree hold-count Description The spanning-tree hold-count command is used to configure the maximum number of BPDU packets transmitted per Hello Time interval. To return to the Syntax default configurations, please use no spanning-tree hold-count command. spanning-tree hold-count value no spanning-tree hold-count Parameter value —— The maximum number of BPDU packets transmitted per Hello Time interval, ranging from 1 to 20 in pps. By default, it is 5. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the hold-count of STP as 8pps: T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree hold-count 8 20.15 spanning-tree max-hops Description The spanning-tree max-hops command is used to configure the maximum number of hops that occur in a specific region before the BPDU is discarded. To return to the default configurations, please use no spanning-tree Syntax max-hops command. spanning-tree max-hops value no spanning-tree max-hops 168 Parameter value —— The maximum number of hops that occur in a specific region before the BPDU is discarded, ranging from 1 to 40 in hop. By default, it is 20. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the max-hops of STP as 30: T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree max-hops 30 20.16 spanning-tree bpdufilter Description The spanning-tree bpdufilter command is used to enable the BPDU filter function for a port. With the function enabled, the port can be prevented from receiving and sending any BPDU packets. To disable the BPDU filter function, Syntax please use no spanning-tree bpdufilter command. spanning-tree bpdufilter no spanning-tree bpdufilter Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the BPDU filter function for port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree bpdufilter 169 20.17 spanning-tree bpduflood Description The spanning-tree bpduflood command is used to enable the BPDU forward function for a port. With the function enabled, the port still can forward spanning tree BPDUs when the spanning tree function is disabled on this port. To disable the BPDU filter function, please use no spanning-tree bpduflood Syntax command. spanning-tree bpduflood no spanning-tree bpduflood Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the BPDU forward function for port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree bpduflood 20.18 spanning-tree bpduguard Description The spanning-tree bpduguard command is used to enable the BPDU protect function for a port. With the BPDU protect function enabled, the port will set itself automatically as ERROR-PORT when it receives BPDU packets, and the port will disable the forwarding function for a while. To disable the BPDU Syntax protect function, please use no spanning-tree bpduguard command. spanning-tree bpduguard no spanning-tree bpduguard 170 Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the BPDU protect function for port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree bpduguard 20.19 spanning-tree guard loop Description The spanning-tree guard loop command is used to enable the Loop Protect function for a port. Loop Protect is to prevent the loops in the network brought by recalculating STP because of link failures and network congestions. To disable the Loop Protect function, please use no Syntax spanning-tree guard loop command. spanning-tree guard loop no spanning-tree guard loop Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the Loop Protect function for port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree guard loop 171 20.20 spanning-tree guard root Description The spanning-tree guard root command is used to enable the Root Protect function for a port. With the Root Protect function enabled, the root bridge will set itself automatically as ERROR-PORT when receiving BPDU packets with higher priority, in order to maintain the role of root ridge. To disable the Syntax Root Protect function, please use no spanning-tree guard root command. spanning-tree guard root no spanning-tree guard root Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the Root Protect function for port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree guard root 20.21 spanning-tree guard tc Description The spanning-tree guard tc command is used to enable the TC Protect of Spanning Tree function for a port. To disable the TC Protect of Spanning Tree function, please use no spanning-tree guard tc command. A switch removes MAC address entries upon receiving TC-BPDUs. If a malicious user continuously sends TC-BPDUs to a switch, the switch will be busy with removing MAC address entries, which may decrease the performance and stability of the network. With the Protect of Spanning Tree function enabled, you can configure the number of TC-BPDUs in a required time, so as to avoid Syntax the process of removing MAC addresses frequently. spanning-tree guard tc 172 no spanning-tree guard tc Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the TC Protect of Spanning Tree for port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree guard tc 20.22 spanning-tree mcheck Description Syntax The spanning-tree mcheck command is used to enable mcheck. spanning-tree mcheck Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable mcheck for port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree mcheck 20.23 show spanning-tree active Description The show spanning-tree active command is used to display the active information of spanning-tree. 173 Syntax show spanning-tree active Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the active information of spanning-tree: T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree active 20.24 show spanning-tree bridge Description The show spanning-tree bridge command is used to display the bridge Syntax parameters. show spanning-tree bridge [ forward-time | hello-time | hold-count | max-age | max-hops | mode | priority | state ] Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the bridge parameters: T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree bridge 20.25 show spanning-tree interface Description The show spanning-tree interface command is used to display the spanning-tree information of all ports or a specified port. 174 Syntax show spanning-tree interface [ gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] [ edge | ext-cost | int-cost | mode | p2p | priority | role | state | status ] Parameter port —— The Ethernet port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the spanning-tree information of all ports: T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree interface Display the spanning-tree information of port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 Display the spanning-tree mode information of port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 mode 20.26 show spanning-tree interface-security Description The show spanning-tree interface-security command is used to display the Syntax protect information of all ports or a specified port. show spanning-tree interface-security [ gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] [ bpdufilter | bpduflood | bpduguard | loop | root | tc ] Parameter port —— The Ethernet port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. 175 Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the protect information of all ports: T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree interface-security Display the protect information of port 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree interface-security gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 Display the interface security bpdufilter information: T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree interface-security bpdufilter 20.27 show spanning-tree mst Description The show spanning-tree mst command is used to display the related Syntax information of MST Instance. show spanning-tree mst { configuration [ digest ] | instance instance-id [ interface [ gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] ] } Parameter instance-id —— Instance ID desired to show, ranging from 1 to 8. port —— The Ethernet port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the region information and mapping information of VLAN and MST Instance: T1600G-28TS(config)#show spanning-tree mst configuration 176 Display the related information of MST Instance 1: T1600G-28TS(config)#show spanning-tree mst instance 1 Display all the ports information of MST Instance 1: T1600G-28TS(config)#show spanning-tree mst instance 1 interface 177 Chapter 21 LLDP Commands LLDP function enables network devices to advertise their own device information periodically to neighbors on the same LAN. The information of the LLDP devices in the LAN can be stored by its neighbor in a standard MIB, so it is possible for the information to be accessed by a Network Management System (NMS) using SNMP. 21.1 lldp Description The lldp command is used to enable LLDP function. To disable the LLDP Syntax function, please use no lldp command. lldp no lldp Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable LLDP function globally: T1600G-28TS(config)#lldp 21.2 lldp forward_message Description The lldp forward_message command is used to enable the switch to forward LLDP messages when LLDP function is disabled. To disable the LLDP messages forwarding function, please use no lldp forward_message command. Syntax lldp forward_message no lldp forward_message 178 Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the switch to forward LLDP messages when LLDP function is disabled globally: T1600G-28TS(config)#lldp forward_message 21.3 lldp hold-multiplier Description The lldp hold-multiplier command is used to configure the Hold Multiplier parameter. The aging time of the local information in the neighbor device is determined by the actual TTL value used in the sending LLDPDU. TTL = Hold Multiplier * Transmit Interval. To return to the default configuration, please Syntax use no lldp hold-multiplier command. lldp hold-multiplier multiplier no lldp hold-multiplier Parameter multiplier —— Configure the Hold Multiplier parameter. It ranges from 2 to 10. By default, it is 4. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify Hold Multiplier as 5: T1600G-28TS(config)#lldp hold-multiplier 5 179 21.4 lldp timer Description The lldp timer command is used to configure the parameters about transmission. To return to the default configuration, please use no lldp timer Syntax command. lldp timer { tx-interval tx-interval | tx-delay tx-delay | reinit-delay reinit-delay | notify-interval notify-interval | fast-count fast-count } no lldp timer { tx-interval | tx-delay | reinit-delay | notify-interval | fast-count } Parameter tx-interval —— Configure the interval for the local device to transmit LLDPDU to its neighbors. The value ranges from 5 to 32768 and the default value is 30 seconds. tx-delay —— Configure a value from 1 to 8192 in seconds to specify the time for the local device to transmit LLDPDU to its neighbors after changes occur so as to prevent LLDPDU being sent frequently. By default, it is 2 seconds. reinit-delay —— This parameter indicates the amount of delay from when LLDP status becomes "disable" until re-initialization will be attempted. The value ranges from 1 to 10 and the default value is 2. notify-interval —— Specify the interval of Trap message which will be sent from local device to network management system. The value ranges from 5 to 3600 and the default value is 5 seconds. fast-count —— When the port's LLDP state transforms from Disable (or Rx_Only) to Tx&Rx (or Tx_Only), the fast start mechanism will be enabled, that is, the transmit interval will be shorten to a second, and several LLDPDUs will be sent out (the number of LLDPDUs equals this parameter). The value ranges from 1 to 10 and the default value is 3. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the Transmit Interval of LLDPDU as 45 seconds and Trap message to NMS as 120 seconds: 180 T1600G-28TS(config)#lldp timer tx-interval 45 T1600G-28TS(config)#lldp timer notify-interval 120 21.5 lldp receive Description The lldp receive command is used to enable the designated port to receive Syntax LLDPDU. To disable the function, please use no lldp receive command. lldp receive no lldp receive Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable port 1/0/1 to receive LLDPDU: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#lldp receive 21.6 lldp transmit Description The lldp transmit command is used to enable the designated port to transmit Syntax LLDPDU. To disable the function, please use no lldp transmit command. lldp transmit no lldp transmit Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) 181 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1 to transmit LLDPDU: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#lldp transmit 21.7 lldp snmp-trap Description The lldp snmp-trap command is used to enable the port’s SNMP notification. If enabled, the port will notify the trap event to network management system. To disable the ports' SNMP notification, please use no lldp snmp-trap Syntax command. lldp snmp-trap no lldp snmp-trap Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the SNMP notification for Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#lldp snmp-trap 182 21.8 lldp tlv-select Description The lldp tlv-select command is used to configure TLVs to be included in outgoing LLDPDU. To exclude TLVs, please use no lldp tlv-select command. Syntax By default, All TLVs are included in outgoing LLDPDU. lldp tlv-select { [ port-description ] [ system-capability ] [ system-description ] [ system-name ] [ management-address ] [ port-vlan ] [ protocol-vlan ] [ vlan-name ] [ link-aggregation ] [ mac-phy-cfg ] [ max-frame-size ] [ power ] [ all ] } no lldp tlv-select { [ port-description ] [ system-capability ] [ system-description ] [ system-name ] [ management-address ] [ port-vlan ] [ protocol-vlan ] [ vlan-name ] [ link-aggregation ] [ mac-phy-cfg ] [ max-frame-size ] [ power ] [ all ] } Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Exclude “management-address” and “port-vlan-id” TLVs in LLDPDU outgoing from Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no lldp tlv-select management-address port-vlan 21.9 lldp management-address Description The lldp management-address command is used to configure the port‘s management address to be included in management address TLV. The NMS uses management addresses to identify the devices. To delete the port‘s management address, please use no lldp management address command. 183 Syntax lldp management-address { ip-address } no lldp management-address Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the port‘s management address as 192.168.1.100 for port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# lldp management-address 192.168.0.100 21.10 lldp med-fast-count Description The lldp med-fast-count command is used to configure the number of the LLDP-MED frames that will be sent out. When LLDP-MED fast start mechanism is activated, multiple LLDP-MED frames will be transmitted based on this parameter. The default value is 4. To return to the default Syntax configuration, please use no lldp med-fast-count command. lldp med-fast-count count no lldp med-fast-count Parameter count —— Configure the Fast Start Count parameter. It ranges from 1 to 10. By default, it is 4. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Specify Fast Start Count as 5: 184 T1600G-28TS(config)# lldp med-fast-count 5 21.11 lldp med-status Description The lldp med-status command is used to enable the LLDP-MED feature for the corresponding port. After the LLDP-MED feature is enabled, the port's Admin Status will be changed to Tx&Rx. To disable the LLDP-MED feature for Syntax the corresponding port, please use no lldp med-status command. lldp med-status no lldp med-status Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the LLDP-MED feature for port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# lldp med-status 21.12 lldp med-tlv-select Description The lldp med-tlv-select command is used to configure LLDP-MED TLVs to be included in outgoing LLDPDU for the corresponding port. To exclude LLDP-MED TLVs, please use no lldp med-tlv-select command. By default, All Syntax TLVs are included in outgoing LLDPDU. lldp med-tlv-select { [inventory-management] [location] [network-policy] [power-management] [all] } no lldp med-tlv-select { [inventory-management] [location] [network-policy] [power-management] [all] } 185 Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Exclude “network policy” and “inventory” TLVs in LLDPDU outgoing from port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no lldp med-tlv-select network-policy inventorymanagement 21.13 lldp med-location Description The lldp med-location command is used to configure the Location Syntax Identification TLV's content in outgoing LLDPDU of the port. lldp med-location { emergency-number identifier | civic-address [ [ language language ] [ province-state province-state ] [ lci-county-name county-name ] [ lci-city city ] [ street street ] [ house-number house-number ] [name name ] [ postal-zipcode postal-zipcode ] [ room-number room-number ] [ post-office-box post-office-box ] [ additional additional ] [ country-code country-code ] [ what { dhcp-server | endpoint | switch } ] ] } Parameter emergency-number —— Emergency Call Service ELIN identifier, which is used during emergency call setup to a traditional CAMA or ISDN trunk-based PSAP. The length of this field ranges from 10 to 25 characters. civic-address —— The civic address is defined to reuse the relevant sub-fields of the DHCP option for civic Address based Location Configuration Information as specified by IETF. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) 186 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the civic address in the Location Identification TLV's content in outgoing LLDPDU of port 1/0/2. Configure the language as English and city as London: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# lldp med-location civic-address language English lci-city London 21.14 show lldp Description The show lldp command is used to display the global configuration of LLDP. Syntax show lldp Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the global configuration of LLDP: T1600G-28TS#show lldp 21.15 show lldp interface Description The show lldp interface command is used to display LLDP configuration of the corresponding port. By default, the LLDP configuration of all the ports will be displayed. Syntax show lldp interface [ gigabitEthernet port ] 187 Parameters port —— The Ethernet port number. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the LLDP configuration of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS#show lldp interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 21.16 show lldp local-information interface Description The show lldp local-information interface command is used to display the LLDP information of the corresponding port. By default, the LLDP information Syntax of all the ports will be displayed. show lldp local-information interface [ gigabitEthernet port ] Parameters port —— The Ethernet port number. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the LLDP information of 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS#show lldp local-information interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 188 21.17 show lldp neighbor-information interface Description The show lldp neighbor-information interface command is used to display the neighbor information of the corresponding port. By default, the neighbor information of all the ports will be displayed. Syntax show lldp neighbor-information interface [ gigabitEthernet port ] Parameters port —— The Ethernet port number. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the neighbor information of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS#show lldp neighbor-information interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 21.18 show lldp traffic interface Description The show lldp traffic interface command is used to display the LLDP statistic information between the local device and neighbor device of the corresponding port. By default, the LLDP statistic information of all the ports Syntax will be displayed. show lldp traffic interface [ gigabitEthernet port ] Parameters port —— The Ethernet port number. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 189 Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the LLDP statistic information of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS#show lldp traffic interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 190 Chapter 22 Static Routes Commands 22.1 ip routing Description This ip routing command is used to enable IPv4 routing globally. To disable IPv4 routing, please use the no ip routing command. Syntax ip routing no ip routing Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable IPv4 routing feature for the switch: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip routing 22.2 interface vlan Description This interface vlan command is used to create the VLAN interface. To delete the specified VLAN interface, please use the no interface vlan command. Syntax interface vlan { vid } no interface vlan { vid } Parameter vid —— The ID of the VLAN. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode 191 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create the VLAN interface 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 2 22.3 interface loopback Description This interface loopback command is used to create the loopback interface. To delete the specified loopback interface, please use the no interface loopback command. Syntax interface loopback { id } no interface loopback { id } Parameter id —— The ID of the loopback interface, ranging from 1 to 64. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create the loopback interface 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface loopback 1 22.4 switchport Description This switchport command is used to switch the Layer 3 interface into the Layer 2 port. To switch the Layer 2 port into the Layer 3 routed port, please use the no switchport command. 192 Syntax switchport no switchport Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Switch port 1/0/9 into the routed port: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/9 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no switchport 22.5 interface range port-channel Description This interface range port-channel command is used to create multiple port-channel interfaces. Syntax interface range port-channel port-channel-list Parameter port-channel-list —— The list of the port-channel interface, ranging from 1 to 14, in the format of 1-3, 5. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create the port-channel interfaces 1, 3, 4 and 5: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface port-channel 1,3-5 193 22.6 description Description This description command is used to add a description to the Layer 3 interface, including routed port, port-channel interface, loopback interface and VLAN interface. To clear the description of the corresponding interface, please use the no description command. Syntax description string no description Parameter string —— Content of an interface description, ranging from 1 to 32 characters. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Add a description system-if to the routed port 1/0/9 : T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/9 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no switchport T1600G-28TS(config-if)# description system-if 22.7 shutdown Description This shutdown command is used to shut down the specified interface. The interface type include: routed port, port-channel interface, loopback interface and VLAN interface. To enable the specified interface, please use the no shutdown command. Syntax shutdown 194 no shutdown Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Shut down the routed port 1/0/9: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/9 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no switchport T1600G-28TS(config-if)# shutdown 22.8 interface port-channel Description This interface port-channel command is used to create the port-channel interface. To delete the specified port-channel interface, please use the no interface port-channel command. Syntax interface port-channel { port-channel-id } no interface port-channel { port-channel-id } Parameter port-channel-id —— The ID of the port-channel interface, ranging from 1 to 14. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create the port-channel interface 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface port-channel 1 195 22.9 ip route Description This ip route command is configure the static route. To clear the corresponding entry, please use the no ip route command. Syntax ip route { dest-address } { mask } { next-hop-address } [ distance ] no ip route { dest-address } { mask } { next-hop-address } Parameter dest-address —— The destination IP address. mask —— The subnet mask. next-hop-address —— The address of the next-hop. distance —— The distance metric of this route, ranging from 1 to 255. The smaller the distance is, the higher the priority is. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create a static route with the destination IP address as 192.168.2.0, the subnet mask as 255.255.255.0 and the next-hop address as 192.168.0.2: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip route 192.168.2.0 255.255.255.0 192.168.0.2 22.10 ipv6 routing Description This ipv6 routing command is enale the IPv6 routing feature globally. To diable IPv6 routing, please use the no ipv6 routing command. Syntax ipv6 routing no ipv6 routing 196 Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable IPv6 routing globally: T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 routing 22.11 ipv6 route Description This ipv6 route command is configure the IPv6 static route. To clear the corresponding entry, please use the no ipv6 route command. Syntax ipv6 route { ipv6-dest-address } { next-hop-address } [ distance ] no ipv6 route { ipv6-dest-address } { next-hop-address } Parameter ipv6-dest-address—— The IPv6 address of the destination network. next-hop-address —— The IPv6 address of the next-hop. distance —— The distance metric of this route, ranging from 1 to 255. The smaller the distance is, the higher the priority is. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create a static route with the destination network IP address as 3200::/64 and the next-hop address as 3100::1234: T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 route 3200::/64 3100::1234 197 22.12 show interface vlan Description The show interface vlan command is used to display the information of the Syntax specified interface VLAN. show interface vlan vid Parameter vid —— The VLAN ID. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the information of VLAN 2: T1600G-28TS(config)#show interface vlan 2 22.13 show ip interface Description This show ip interface command is used to display the detailed information of the specified Layer 3 interface. Syntax show ip interface [ gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id | loopback id | vlan vlan-id ] Parameter port —— The port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Member ports in this port channel should all be routed ports. id —— The loopback interface ID. vlan-id —— The VLAN interface ID. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 198 Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the detailed information of the VLAN interface 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip interface vlan 2 22.14 show ip interface brief Description This show ip interface brief command is used to display the summary information of the Layer 3 interfaces. Syntax show ip interface brief Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the summary information of the Layer 3 interfaces: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip interface brief 22.15 show ip route Description This show ip route command is used to display the route entries of the specified type. Syntax show ip route [ static | connected ] Parameter static | connected —— Specify the route type. If not specified, all types of route entries will be displayed. static: The static routes. 199 connected: The connected routes. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the static routes: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip route static 22.16 show ip route specify Description This show ip route specify command is used to display the valid routing information to the specified IP address or network segments. Syntax show ip route specify { ip } [ mask ] [ longer-prefixes ] Parameter ip —— Specify the destination IP address. mask —— Specify the destination IP address together with the parameter ip. longer-prefixes —— Specify the destination subnets that match the network segment determined by the ip and mask parameters. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the shortest route to 192.168.0.100: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip route specify 192.168.0.100 Look up the route entry with the destination as 192.168.0.0/24: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip route specify 192.168.0.0 255.255.255.0 Display the routes to all the subnets that belongs to 192.168.0.0/16: 200 T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip route specify 192.168.0.0 255.255.0.0 longer-prefixes 22.17 show ip route summary Description This show ip route summary command is used to display the summary information of the route entries classified by their sources. Syntax show ip route summary Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the summary information of route entries: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip route summary 22.18 show ipv6 interface Description This command is used to display the configured IPv6 information of the management interface, including ipv6 function status, link-local address and global address, IPv6 multicast groups etc. Syntax show ipv6 interface Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the IPv6 information of the management interface: 201 T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 interface 22.19 show ipv6 route Description This show ipv6 route command is used to display the IPv6 route entries of the specified type. Syntax show ipv6 route [ static | connected ] Parameter static | connected —— Specify the route type. If not specified, all types of route entries will be displayed. static: The static routes. connected: The connected routes. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the IPv6 static routes: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 route static 22.20 show ipv6 route summary Description This show ipv6 route summary command is used to display the summary information of the IPv6 route entries classified by their sources. Syntax show ipv6 route summary Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 202 Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the summary information of IPv6 route entries: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 route summary 203 Chapter 23 IPv6 Address Configuration Commands The IPv6 address configuration commands are provided in the Interface Configuration Mode, which includes the routed port, the port-channel interface and the VLAN interface. Enter the configuration mode of these Layer 3 interfaces and configure their IPv6 parameters. 23.1 ipv6 enable Description This command is used to enable the IPv6 function on the specified Layer 3 interface. IPv6 function should be enabled before the IPv6 address configuration management. By default it is enabled on VLAN interface 1. IPv6 function can only be enabled on one Layer 3 interface at a time. If the IPv6 function is disabled, the corresponding IPv6-based modules will be invalid, for example SSHv6, SSLv6, TFTPv6 and more. To disable the IPv6 function, please use no ipv6 enable command. Syntax ipv6 enable no ipv6 enable Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the IPv6 function on the VLAN interface 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 enable 23.2 ipv6 address autoconfig Description This command is used to enable the automatic configuration of the ipv6 link-local address. The switch has only one ipv6 link-local address, which can be configured automatically or manually. The general ipv6 link-local address 204 has the prefix as fe80::/10. IPv6 routers cannot forward packets that have link-local source or destination addresses to other links. The autu-configured ipv6 link-local address is in EUI-64 format. To verify the uniqueness of the link-local address, the manually configured ipv6 link-local address will be deleted when the auto-configured ipv6 link-local address takes effect. Syntax ipv6 address autoconfig Configuration Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the automatic configuration of the ipv6 link-local address on VLAN interface 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 address autoconfig 23.3 ipv6 address link-local Description The ipv6 address link-local command is used to configure the ipv6 link-local address manually on a specified interface. To delete the configured link-local address, please use no ipv6 address link-local command. Syntax ipv6 address ipv6-addr link-local no ipv6 address ipv6-addr link-local Parameter ipv6-addr —— The link-local address of the interface. It should be a standardized IPv6 address with the prefix fe80::/10, otherwise this command will be invalid. Configuration Mode Interface Configuration Mode 205 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the link-local address as fe80::1234 on the VLAN interface 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 address fe80::1234 link-local 23.4 ipv6 address dhcp Description The ipv6 address dhcp command is used to enable the DHCPv6 Client function. When this function is enabled, the Layer 3 interface will try to obtain IP from DHCPv6 server. To delete the allocated IP from DHCPv6 server and disable the DHCPv6 Client function, please use no ipv6 address dhcp command. Syntax ipv6 address dhcp no ipv6 address dhcp Configuration Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the DHCP Client function on VLAN interface 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 address dhcp 23.5 ipv6 address ra Description This command is used to configure the interface’s global IPv6 address according to the address prefix and other configuration parameters from its 206 received RA(Router Advertisement) message. To disable this function, please use no ipv6 address ra command. Syntax ipv6 address ra no ipv6 address ra Configuration Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the automatic ipv6 address configuration function to obtain IPv6 address through the RA message on VLAN interface 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 address ra 23.6 ipv6 address eui-64 Description This command is used to manually configure a global IPv6 address with an extended unique identifier (EUI) in the low-order 64 bits on the interface. Specify only the network prefix. The last 64 bits are automatically computed from the switch MAC address. To remove a EUI-64 IPv6 address from the interface, please use the no ipv6 address eui-64 command. Syntax ipv6 address ipv6-addr eui-64 no ipv6 address ipv6-addr eui-64 Parameter ipv6-addr —— Global IPv6 address with 64 bits network prefix, for example 3ffe::/64. Configuration Mode Interface Configuration Mode 207 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure an EUI-64 global address on the interface with the network prefix 3ffe::/64: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 address 3ffe::/64 eui-64 23.7 ipv6 address Description This command is used to manually configure a global IPv6 address on the interface. To remove a global IPv6 address from the interface, please use no ipv6 address command. Syntax ipv6 address ipv6-addr no ipv6 address ipv6-addr Parameter ipv6-addr —— Global IPv6 address with network prefix, for example 3ffe::1/64. Configuration Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the global address 3001::1/64 on VLAN interface 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 address 3001::1/64 208 23.8 show ipv6 interface Description This command is used to display the configured ipv6 information of the management interface, including ipv6 function status, link-local address and global address, ipv6 multicast groups etc. Syntax show ipv6 interface Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the ipv6 information of the management interface: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 interface 209 Chapter 24 ARP Commands Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) is used to resolve an IP address into an Ethernet MAC address. The switch maintains an ARP mapping table to record the IP-to-MAC mapping relations, which is used for forwarding packets. An ARP mapping table contains two types of ARP entries: dynamic and static. An ARP dynamic entry is automatically created and maintained by ARP. A static ARP entry is manually configured and maintained. 24.1 arp Description This arp command is used to add a static ARP entry. To delete the specified ARP entry, please use the no arp command. Syntax arp ip mac type no arp ip type Parameter ip —— The IP address of the static ARP entry. mac —— The MAC address of the static ARP entry. type —— The ARP type. Configure it as “arpa”. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create a static ARP entry with the IP as 192.168.0.1 and the MAC as 00:11:22:33:44:55: T1600G-28TS(config)# arp 192.168.0.1 00:11:22:33:44:55 arpa 210 24.2 clear arp-cache Description This clear arp-cache command is used to clear all the dynamic ARP entries. Syntax clear arp-cache Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Clear all the dynamic ARP entries: T1600G-28TS(config)# clear arp-cache 24.3 arp dynamicrenew Description This arp dynamicrenew command is used to automatically renew dynamic ARP entries. To disable the switch to automatically renew dynamic ARP entries, please use the no arp dynamicremew command. By default, it is enabled. Syntax arp dynamicremew no arp dynamicremew Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the switch to automatically renew the dynamic ARP entries: T1600G-28TS(config)# arp dynamicrenew 211 24.4 arp timeout Description This arp timeout command is used to configure the ARP aging time of the interface. Syntax arp timeout timeout no arp timeout Parameter timeout —— Specify the aging time, ranging from 10 to 3000 seconds. The default value is 1200 seconds. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the ARP aging time as 60 seconds: T1600G-28TS(config)# arp timeout 60 24.5 gratuitous-arp intf-status-up enable Description This gratuitous-arp intf-status-up enable command is used to enable the Layer 3 interface to send a gratuitous ARP packet when the interface’s status becomes up. Syntax gratuitous-arp intf-status-up enable no gratuitous-arp intf-status-up enable Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 212 Privilege Requirement None. Example Enable the switch’s Layer 3 interfaces to send gratuitous ARP packets when their status becomes up: T1600G-28TS(config)# gratuitous-arp intf-status-up enable 24.6 gratuitous-arp dup-ip-detected enable Description This gratuitous-arp dup-ip-detected enable command is used to enable the Layer 3 interface to send a gratuitous ARP packet when receiving a gratuitous packets of which the IP address is the same as its own. Syntax gratuitous-arp dup-ip-detected enable no gratuitous-arp dup-ip-detected enable Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Enable the switch’s Layer 3 interface to send gratuitous ARP packets when receiving a gratuitous packets of which the IP address is the same as its own: T1600G-28TS(config)# gratuitous-arp dup-ip-detected enable 24.7 gratuitous-arp learning enable Description This gratuitous-arp learning enable command is used to enable the Layer 3 interface to learn MAC addresses from the gratuitous ARP packets. Syntax gratuitous-arp learning enable no gratuitous-arp learning enable 213 Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Enable the Layer 3 interface to learn MAC addresses from the gratuitous ARP packets: T1600G-28TS(config)# gratuitous-arp learning enable 24.8 gratuitous-arp send-interval Description This gratuitous-arp send-interval command is used to configure the interval at which the interface periodically send the gratuitous ARP packets. Syntax gratuitous-arp send-interval interval Parameter Interval —— Specify the interval at which the interface periodically send the gratuitous ARP packets. Value 0 means the interface will not send gratuitous ARP packets. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface vlan / interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement None. Example Specify the interface VLAN 1 to send gratuitous ARP packets every 1 second: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# gratuitous-arp send-interval 1 214 24.9 ip proxy-arp Description The ip proxy-arp command is used to enable Proxy ARP function on the specified VLAN interface or routed port. To disable Proxy ARP on this interface, please use no ip proxy-arp command. Syntax ip proxy-arp no ip proxy-arp Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement None Example Enable the Proxy ARP function on VLAN Interface 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip proxy-arp Enable the Proxy ARP function on routed port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no switchport T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip proxy-arp 24.10 ip local-proxy-arp Description The ip local-proxy-arp command is used to enable Local Proxy ARP function on the specified VLAN interface or routed port. To disable Local Proxy ARP function on this interface, please use no ip local-proxy-arp command. Syntax ip local-proxy-arp no ip local-proxy-arp 215 Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (Interface vlan / interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement None Example Enable the Proxy ARP function on VLAN Interface 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip local-proxy-arp Enable the Proxy ARP function on routed port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no switchport T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip local-proxy-arp 24.11 show arp Description This show arp command is used to display the active ARP entries. If no parameter is speicified, all the active ARP entries will be displayed. Syntax show arp [ ip ] [ mac ] Parameter ip —— Specify the IP address of your desired ARP entry. mac —— Specify the MAC address of your desired ARP entry. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. 216 Example Display the ARP entry with the IP as 192.168.0.2: T1600G-28TS(config)# show arp 192.168.0.2 24.12 show ip arp (interface) Description This show ip arp (interface) command is used to display the active ARP entries associated with a specified Layer 3 interface. Syntax show ip arp { gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id | vlan id } Parameter port —— Specify the number of the routed port. port-channel-id —— Specify the ID of the port channel. id —— Specify the VLAN interface ID. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the ARP entry associated with VLAN interface 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip arp vlan 2 24.13 show ip arp summary Description This show ip arp summary command is used to display the number of the active ARP entries. Syntax show ip arp summary Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 217 Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the number of the ARP entries: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip arp summary 24.14 show gratuitous-arp Description This show gratuitous arp command is used to display the configuration of gratuitous ARP. Syntax show gratuitous-arp Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configuration of gratuitous ARP: T1600G-28TS(config)# show gratuitous-arp 24.15 show ip proxy-arp Description The show ip proxy-arp command is used to display the Proxy ARP status. Syntax show ip proxy-arp Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None 218 Example Display the Proxy ARP status: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip proxy-arp 219 Chapter 25 DHCP Server Commands DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) is a network configuration protocol for hosts on TCP/IP networks, and it provides a framework for distributing configuration information to hosts. DHCP server assigns IP addresses from specified address pools on a switch or router to DHCP clients and manages them. 25.1 service dhcp server Description The service dhcp server command is used to enable DHCP service globally. To disable DHCP server service, please use no service dhcp server command. Syntax service dhcp server no service dhcp server Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable DHCP server service globally: T1600G-28TS(config)# service dhcp server 25.2 ip dhcp server extend-option capwap-ac-ip Description The ip dhcp server extend-option capwap-ac-ip command is used to configure the IP address of the remote DHCP server. To delete the remote DHCP server’s IP address, please use no ip dhcp server extend-option capwap-ac-ip command. Syntax ip dhcp server extend-option capwap-ac-ip ip-address no ip dhcp server extend-option capwap-ac-ip 220 Parameter ip-address —— Specify the IP address of the remote server. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Set the remote DHCP server’s IP address as 192.168.3.1: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server extend-option capwap-ac-ip 192.168.3.1 25.3 ip dhcp server extend-option vendor-class-id Description The ip dhcp server extend-option vendor-class-id command is used to configure the class ID of the packets from DHCP server in a different network segment. To delete the class ID settings, please use no ip dhcp server extend-option vendor-class-id command. Syntax ip dhcp server extend-option vendor-class-id class-id no ip dhcp server extend-option vendor-class-id Parameter class-id —— Specify the class ID of the DHCP packets from another network segment. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Set the class ID of the DHCP packets from another network segment as 34: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server extend-option vendor-class-id 34 221 25.4 ip dhcp server exclude-address Description The ip dhcp server exclude-address command is used to specify the reserved IP addresses which are forbidden to allocate, such as the gateway address, the network segment broadcast address, the server address etc. To delete the reserved IP addresses, please use no ip dhcp server exclude-address command. Syntax ip dhcp server exclude-address start-ip-address end-ip-address no ip dhcp server exclude-address start-ip-addr end-ip-address Parameter start-ip-address —— Specify the start IP address of the reserved IP pool. end-ip-address —— Specify the end IP address of the reserved IP pool. Only one IP address will be reserved if the end IP address and the start IP address are the same. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Set the reserved IP addresses from 192.168.1.1 to 192.168.1.9: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server exclude-address 192.168.1.1 192.168.1.9 25.5 ip dhcp server pool Description The ip dhcp server pool command is used to create the address pool of DHCP Server and enter the dhcp configuration mode. To delete the address pool, please use no ip dhcp server pool command. Syntax ip dhcp server pool pool-name no ip dhcp server pool pool-name 222 Parameter pool-name —— Specify the address pool name, ranging from 1 to 8 characters. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create the address pool of name POOL1: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool POOL1 25.6 ip dhcp server ping timeout Description The ip dhcp server ping timeout command is used to specify the timeout of PING process. To resume the default value, please use no ip dhcp server ping timeout command. Syntax ip dhcp server ping timeout value no ip dhcp server ping timeout Parameter value —— Specify the timeout value, ranging from 100 to 10000ms. The default value is 100ms. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Set the timeout of PING as 200ms: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server ping timeout 200 223 25.7 ip dhcp server ping packets Description The ip dhcp server ping packets command is used to specify the number of PING packets sent. If this value is set to 0, the PING process will be disabled. To resume the default value, please use no ip dhcp server ping packets command. Syntax ip dhcp server ping packets num Parameter num —— Specify the PING packets’ number, ranging from 0 to 10. By default it’s 1. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the PING packets’ number as 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server ping packets 2 25.8 network Description The network command is used to specify the address and subnet of the network pool. Syntax network network-address subnet-mask Parameter network-address —— Specify the network address of the pool, with the format A.B.C.D. All the IP addresses in the same subnet are allocatable except the reserved addresses and specific addresses. subnet-mask —— Specify the subnet mask of the pool, with the format A.B.C.D. 224 Command Mode DHCP Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the address pool “product” as 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# network 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0 25.9 lease Description The lease command is used to specify the lease time of the address pool. Syntax lease lease-time Parameter lease-time —— Specify the lease time of the pool, ranging from 1 to 2880 minutes. The default value is 120 minutes. Command Mode DHCP Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the lease time of address pool “product” as 10 minutes: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# lease 10 225 25.10 address hardware-address Description The address hardware-address command is used to reserve the static address bound with hardware address in the address pool. To delete the binding, please use no address hardware-address. Syntax address ip-address hardware-address hardware-address hardware-type { ethernet | ieee802 } no address ip-address Parameter ip-address —— Specify the static binding IP address. hardware-address —— Specify the hardware address, in the format XX:XX:XX:XX:XX:XX. ethernet | ieee802 —— Specify the hardware type. Command Mode DHCP Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Reserve the IP address 192.168.0.10 in the address pool “product” for the device with the MAC address as 5e:4c:a6:31:24:01 and the hardware type as ethernet: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# address 192.168.0.10 hardware-address 5e:4c:a6:31:24:01 hardware-type ethernet 25.11 address client-identifier Description The address client-identifier command is used to specify the static address bound with client ID in the address pool. To delete the binding, please use no address command. 226 Syntax address ip-address client-identifier client-id [ascii] no address ip-address Parameter ip-address —— Specify the static binding IP address. client-id —— Specify the client ID, in the format of hex value. ascii —— The client ID is entered with ASCII characters. Command Mode DHCP Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Reserve the IP address 192.168.0.10 in the address pool “product” for the device with the client ID as abc in ASCII: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp pool product T1600G-28TS(dhcp-config)# address 192.168.0.10 client-identifier abc ascii 25.12 default-gateway Description The default-gateway command is used to specify the default gateway of the address pool. To delete the configuration, please use no default-gateway. Syntax default-gateway gateway-list no default-gateway Parameter gateway-list —— Specify the gateway list, with the format of A.B.C.D,E.F.G.H. At most 8 gateways can be configured, separated by comma. Command Mode DHCP Configuration Mode 227 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the address pool product’s default gateways as 192.168.0.1 and 192.168.1.1: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product T1600G-28TS(dhcp-config)# default-gateway 192.168.0.1,192.168.1.1 25.13 dns-server Description The dns-server command is used to specify the DNS server of the address pool. To delete this configuration, please use no dns-server command. Syntax dns-server dns-list no dns-server Parameter dns-list —— Specify the DNS server list, with the format of A.B.C.D,E.F.G.H. At most 8 DNS servers can be configured, separated by comma. Command Mode DHCP Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the address pool’s DNS servers as 192.168.0.1 and 192.168.1.1: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# dns-server 192.168.0.1,192.168.1.1 228 25.14 netbios-name-server Description The netbios-name-server command is used to specify the Netbios server’s IP address. To delete the Netbios servers, please use no netbios-name-server command. Syntax netbios-name-server NBNS-list no netbios-name-server Parameter NBNS-list —— Specify the Netbios server list, with the format of A.B.C.D,E.F.G.H. At most 8 Netbios servers can be configured, separated by comma. Command Mode DHCP Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the address pool’s Netbios servers as 192.168.0.1 and 192.168.1.1: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# netbios-name-server 192.168.0.1,192.168.1.1 25.15 netbios-node-type Description The netbios-node-type command is used to specify the Netbios server’s node type. To delete the node type setttings, please use no netbios-node-type command. Syntax netbios-node-type type no netbios-node-type Parameter type —— Specify the node type as b-node, h-node, m-node or p-node. 229 Command Mode DHCP Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the address pool’s Netbios server type as b-node: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# netbios-node-type b-node 25.16 next-server Description The next-server command is used to specify the next DHCP server’s address during the DHCP boot process. To delete the next server, please use no next-server command. Syntax next-server ip-address next-server Parameter ip-address —— Specify the IP address of the next server. Command Mode DHCP Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the next server’s IP address as 192.168.2.1: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# next-server 192.168.2.1 230 25.17 domain-name Description The domain-name command is used to specify the domain name for the DHCP client. To delete the domain name, please use no domain-name command. Syntax domain-name domainname no domain-name Parameter domainname —— Specify the domain name for the DHCP client. Command Mode DHCP Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the DHCP client’s domain name as edu: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# domain-name edu 25.18 bootfile Description The bootfilecommand is used to specify the name of the DHCP client’s bootfile. To delete the bootfile, please use no bootfile command. Syntax bootfile file-name no bootfile Parameter file-name —— Specify the name of the DHCP client’s bootfile. Command Mode DHCP Configuration Mode 231 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the name of the DHCP client’s bootfile as boot1: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# bootfile boot1 25.19 show ip dhcp server status Description The show ip dhcp server status command is used to display the status of the DHCP service. Syntax show ip dhcp server status Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the status of DHCP service: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp server status 25.20 show ip dhcp server statistics Description The show ip dhcp server statistics command is used to display the DHCP packets received and sent by DHCP server. Syntax show ip dhcp server statistics Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 232 Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the statistics of DHCP packets received and sent by the DHCP server: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp server statistics 25.21 show ip dhcp server extend-option Description The show ip dhcp server extend-option command is used to display the configuration of the remote DCHP servers. Syntax show ip dhcp server extend-option Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configurations of the remote DCHP servers: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp server extend-option 25.22 show ip dhcp server pool Description The show ip dhcp server pool command is used to display the configuration of the address pool. Syntax show ip dhcp server pool Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. 233 Example Display the configured address pool: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp server pool 25.23 show ip dhcp server excluded-address Description The show ip dhcp server excluded-address command is used to display the configuration of reserved addresses. Syntax show ip dhcp server excluded-address Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configured reserved addresses: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp server excluded-address 25.24 show ip dhcp server manual-binding Description The show ip dhcp server manual-binding command is used to display the configuration of static binding address. Syntax show ip dhcp server manual-binding Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. 234 Example Display the configured static binding address: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp server manual-binding 25.25 show ip dhcp server binding Description The show ip dhcp server binding command is used to display the binding entries. Syntax show ip dhcp server binding [ ip ip-address ] Parameter ip-address —— Specify the binding IP address. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the address binding entries: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp server binding 25.26 clear ip dhcp server statistics Description The clear ip dhcp server statistics command is used to clear the statistics information of DHCP packets. Syntax clear ip dhcp server statistics Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 235 Example Clear the packet statistics: T1600G-28TS(config)# clear ip dhcp server statistics 25.27 clear ip dhcp server binding Description The clear ip dhcp server binding command is used to clear the binding information. Syntax clear ip dhcp server binding [ ip-address ] Parameter ip-address —— Specify the binding IP address. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Clear all the binding addresses: T1600G-28TS(config)# clear ip dhcp server binding 236 Chapter 26 DHCP Relay Commands A DHCP Relay agent is a Layer 3 device that forwards DHCP packets between clients and servers. DHCP Relay forward requests and replies between clients and servers when they are not on the same physical subnet. 26.1 service dhcp relay Description The service dhcp relay command is used to enable DHCP Relay function globally. To disable DHCP Relay function, please use no service dhcp relay command. Syntax service dhcp relay no service dhcp relay Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable DHCP Relay function globally: T1600G-28TS(config)# service dhcp relay 26.2 ip dhcp relay hops Description The ip dhcp relay hops command is used to specify the maximum hops (DHCP Relay agent) that the DHCP packets can be relayed. To restore the default value, please use no service dhcp relay hops command. Syntax ip dhcp relay hops hops no ip dhcp relay hops 237 Parameter hops ——Specify the maximum hops (DHCP Relay agent) that the DHCP packets can be relayed. If a packet’s hop count is more than the value you set here, the packet will be dropped. The valid value ranges from the 1 to 16, and the default value is 4. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the maximum number of relay hops as 6: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp relay hops 6 26.3 ip dhcp relay time Description The ip dhcp relay time command is used to specify the DHCP relay time threshold. DHCP relay time is the time elapsed since client began address acquisition or renewal process. When the elapsed time of the DHCP packet is greater than the value set here, the DHCP packet will be dropped by the switch. To restore the default value, please use no service dhcp relay time command. Syntax ip dhcp relay time time no ip dhcp relay time Parameter time ——Specify the DHCP relay time threshold. The valid value ranges from 1 to 65535. The default value is 0, which means the switch will not examine this field of the DHCP packets. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 238 Example Configure the DHCP Relay time as 30 seconds: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp relay time 30 26.4 ip helper-address Description The ip helper-address command is used to add DHCP Server address to the Layer 3 interface. To delete the server address, please use no ip helper-address command. Syntax ip helper-address ip-address no ip helper-address [ ip-address ] Parameter ip-address —— DHCP Server address. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Add DHCP Server address 192.168.2.1 to interface VLAN 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip helper-address 192.168.2.1 26.5 ip dhcp relay information Description The ip dhcp relay information command is used to enable option 82 support in DHCP Relay. To disable this function, please use no ip dhcp relay information command. Syntax ip dhcp relay information no ip dhcp relay information 239 Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet/interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable option 82 support in DHCP Relay for port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp relay information 26.6 ip dhcp relay information strategy Description The ip dhcp relay information strategy command is used to specify the operation for the Option 82 field of the DHCP request packets from the Host. To restore to the default option, please use no ip dhcp relay information strategy command. Syntax ip dhcp relay information strategy { drop | keep | replace } no ip dhcp relay information strategy Parameter drop | keep | replace ——The operations for Option 82 field of the DHCP request packets from the Host. The default operation is keep. drop: Discard the packet with the Option 82 field. keep: Keep the Option 82 field in the packet. replace: Replace the option 82 field with the system option defined by the switch. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 240 Example Specify the option 82 strategy as replace to replace the Option 82 field with the local parameter on receiving the DHCP request packet for port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp relay information strategy replace 26.7 ip dhcp relay information format Description The ip dhcp relay information format command is used to select the format of option 82 sub-option value field. To restore to the default option, please use no ip dhcp relay information format command. Syntax ip dhcp relay information format { normal | private } no ip dhcp relay information format Parameter normal | private —— The format type of option 82 sub-option value field. normal: Indicates that the format of sub-option value field is TLV (type-length-value). private: Indicates that the format of sub-option value field is the value you configure for the related sub-option. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Select the format of option 82 sub-option value field as TLV (type-length-value) for port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip dhcp relay information format normal 241 26.8 ip dhcp relay information circuit-id Description The ip dhcp relay information circuit-id command is used to specify the custom circuit ID when option 82 customization is enabled. To clear the circuit ID, please use no ip dhcp relay information circuit-id command. Syntax ip dhcp relay information circuit-id circuitID no ip dhcp relay information circuit-id Parameter circuitID —— Specify the circuit ID, ranging from 1 to 64 characters. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the circuit ID as “TP-Link” for port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp relay information circuit-id TP-Link 26.9 ip dhcp relay information remote-id Description The ip dhcp relay information remote-id command is used to specify the custom remote ID when option 82 customization is enabled. To clear the remote ID, please use no ip dhcp relay information remote-id command. Syntax ip dhcp relay information remote-id remoteID no ip dhcp relay information remote-id Parameter remoteID —— Specify the remote ID, ranging from 1 to 64 characters. 242 Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the remote ID as “TP-Link” for port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp relay information remote-id TP-Link 26.10 ip dhcp relay default-interface Description The ip dhcp relay default-interface command is used to configure default relay agent interface. When the switch works at DHCP VLAN Relay mode and there is no IP interface in the VLAN, the switch uses the IP of default relay agent interface to fill in the relay agent IP address field of DHCP packets. To delete the default relay agent interface use no ip dhcp relay default-interface. Syntax ip dhcp relay default-interface no ip dhcp relay default-interface Command mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure interface VLAN 1 as the default relay agent interface: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp relay default-interface 243 26.11 ip dhcp relay vlan Description The ip dhcp relay vlan command is used to add DHCP server address to specified VLAN. If there is an IP interface in the VLAN and it has configured a DHCP server address at the interface level, then the configuration at the interface level has higher priority. In this case, the DHCP server configured on the VLAN will not be used to forward the DHCP packets. To delete the DHCP server address use no ip dhcp relay vlan. Syntax ip dhcp relay vlan vid helper-address ip-address no ip dhcp relay vlan vid helper-address [ ip-address ] Parameter vid —— VLAN ID. ip-address —— DHCP Server address. Command mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Add DHCP server address 192.168.2.1 to VLAN 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp relay vlan 1 helper-address 192.168.2.1 26.12 show ip dhcp relay Description The show ip dhcp relay command is used to display the global status and Option 82 configuration of DHCP Relay. Syntax show ip dhcp relay Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 244 Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configuration of DHCP Relay: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp relay 245 Chapter 27 DHCP L2 Relay Commands 27.1 ip dhcp l2relay Description The ip dhcp l2relay command is used to enable DHCP L2 Relay function globally. To disable DHCP L2 Relay function, please use no ip dhcp l2relay command. Syntax ip dhcp l2relay no ip dhcp l2relay Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable DHCP L2 Relay function globally: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp l2relay 27.2 ip dhcp l2relay vlan Description The ip dhcp l2relay vlan command is used to enable DHCP L2 relay in the specified VLAN. To disable DHCP L2 Relay in the specific vlan, please use no ip dhcp l2relay vlan command. Syntax ip dhcp l2relay vlan vlan-range no ip dhcp l2relay vlan vlan-range Parameter vlan-range —— Specify the vlan to be enabled with DHCP L2 relay. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode 246 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable DHCP L2 Relay for VLAN 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp l2relay vlan 2 27.3 ip dhcp l2relay information Description The ip dhcp l2relay information command is used to enable option 82 support in DHCP Relay. To disable this function, please use no ip dhcp l2relay information command. Syntax ip dhcp l2relay information no ip dhcp l2relay information Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable option 82 support in DHCP Relay for port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp l2relay information 27.4 ip dhcp l2relay information strategy Description The ip dhcp l2relay information strategy command is used to specify the operation for the Option 82 field of the DHCP request packets from the Host. To restore to the default option, please use no ip dhcp l2relay information strategy command. 247 Syntax ip dhcp l2relay information strategy { drop | keep | replace } no ip dhcp l2relay information strategy Parameter drop | keep | replace —— The operations for Option 82 field of the DHCP request packets from the Host. The default operation is keep. drop: Discard the packet with the Option 82 field. keep: Keep the Option 82 field in the packet. replace: Replace the option 82 field with the system option defined by the switch. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the option 82 strategy as replace to replace the Option 82 field with the local parameter on receiving the DHCP request packet for port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp l2relay information strategy replace 27.5 ip dhcp l2relay information format Description The ip dhcp l2relay information format command is used to select the format of option 82 sub-option value field. To restore to the default option, please use no ip dhcp l2relay information format command. Syntax ip dhcp l2relay information format { normal | private } no ip dhcp l2relay information format Parameter normal | private —— The format type of option 82 sub-option value field. 248 normal: Indicates that the format of sub-option value field is TLV (type-length-value). private: Indicates that the format of sub-option value field is the value you configure for the related sub-option. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Select the format of option 82 sub-option value field as TLV (type-length-value) for port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip dhcp l2relay information format normal 27.6 ip dhcp l2relay information circuit-id Description The ip dhcp l2relay information circuit-id command is used to specify the custom circuit ID when option 82 customization is enabled. To clear the circuit ID, please use no ip dhcp l2relay information circuit-id command. Syntax ip dhcp l2relay information circuit-id circuitID no ip dhcp l2relay information circuit-id Parameter circuitID —— Specify the circuit ID, ranging from 1 to 64 characters. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 249 Example Specify the circuit ID as “TP-Link” for port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp l2relay information circuit-id TP-Link 27.7 ip dhcp l2relay information remote-id Description The ip dhcp l2relay information remote-id command is used to specify the custom remote ID when option 82 customization is enabled. To clear the remote ID, please use no ip dhcp l2relay information remote-id command. Syntax ip dhcp l2relay information remote-id remoteID no ip dhcp l2relay information remote-id Parameter remoteID —— Specify the remote ID, ranging from 1 to 64 characters. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the remote ID as “TP-Link” for port 2: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp l2relay information remote-id TP-Link 27.8 show ip dhcp l2relay Description The show ip dhcp l2relay command is used to display the global status and Option 82 configuration of DHCP Relay. Syntax show ip dhcp l2relay 250 Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configuration of DHCP Relay: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp l2relay 27.9 show ip dhcp l2relay interface Description The show ip dhcp l2relay interface command is used to display the DHCP L2 Relay status for the ports. Syntax show ip dhcp l2relay interface [ gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configuration of DHCP L2 Relay: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp l2relay interface 251 Chapter 28 QoS Commands QoS (Quality of Service) function is used to optimize the network performance. It provides you with network service experience of a better quality. The switch implements three priority modes based on port, on 802.1p and on DSCP. 28.1 qos trust mode Description The qos trust mode command is used to configure the trust mode of CoS (Class of Service) function for the ports. The default trust mode is trust port Syntax priority. qos trust mode { dot1p | dscp | untrust } Parameter dot1p—— Trust 802.1p mode. In this mode, data will be classified into different services based on the 802.1p priority. dscp—— Trust dscp mode. In this mode, data will be classified into different services based on the dscp priority. untrust—— Trust port mode. In this mode, data will be classified into different services based on the based on the port priority. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Set the trust mode of port 1/0/3 as dscp: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# qos trust mode dscp 252 28.2 qos port-priority Description The qos port-priority command is used to configure the port to 802.1p priority mapping for the desired port. To return to the default configuration, please use no qos port-priority command. When Port Priority is enabled, the packets will be mapped to different priority queues based on the ingress Syntax ports. qos port-priority { dot1p-priority } no qos port-priority Parameter dot1p-priority —— The 802.1p priority that the packets will be mapped to from the desired port. It ranges from 0 to 7, which represent 802.1p priority 0-7 respectively. By default, the priority is 0. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the priority of port 5 as 3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# qos port-priority 3 28.3 qos cos-map Description The qos cos-map command is used to configure 802.1p to queue mapping globally. To return to the default configuration, please use no qos cos-map command. When 802.1P Priority is enabled, the packets with 802.1Q tag are mapped to different priority levels based on 802.1P priority. 253 Syntax qos cos-map { dot1p-priority } { tc-queue } no qos cos-map Parameter dot1p-priority —— The value of 802.1p priority. It ranges from 0 to 7, which represent 802.1p priority 0-7 respectively. tc-queue—— The number of TC queue that the 80.1p priority will be mapped to. It ranges from 0 to 7. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Map the 802.1p priority 5 to TC-2: T1600G-28TS (config)# qos cos-map 5 2 28.4 qos dot1p-remap Description The qos dot1p-remap command is used to configure the 802.1p to 802.1p mappings. To return to the default configuration, please use no qos dot1p-remap command. When 802.1p remap is configured, the packets with Syntax the specific 802.1p priority will tagged with the desired new 802.1p priority. qos dot1p-remap { dot1p-priority } { new-dot1p-priority } no qos dot1p-remap Parameter dot1p-priority —— The original 802.1p priority. It ranges from 0 to 7, which represent 802.1p priority 0-7 respectively. new-dot1p-priority—— The new 802.1p priority. It ranges from 0 to 7. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode 254 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Remap 802.1p priority 5 to 802.1p priority 6: T1600G-28TS(config)#qos dot1p-remap 5 6 28.5 qos dscp-map Description The qos dscp-map command is used to configure the DSCP to 802.1p mapping. To return to the default configuration, please use no qos dscp-map command. DSCP (DiffServ Code Point) is a new definition to IP ToS field given by IEEE. This field is used to divide IP datagram into 64 priorities. When DSCP Priority is enabled, IP datagram are mapped to different priority levels based Syntax on DSCP priority. qos dscp-map { dscp-value-list } { dot1p-priority } no qos dscp-map Parameter dscp-value-list —— The DSCP value list in the format of “1-3,5,7”. The valid values are from 0 to 63. dot1p-priority ——The 802.1p priority to which the DSCP priority will be mapped. It ranges from 0 to 7, which represent 802.1p priority 0-7 respectively. By default, the priority is 0. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 255 Example Map DSCP Priority 5 to 802.1p priority 2: T1600G-28TS(config)#qos dscp-map 5 2 28.6 qos dscp-remap Description The qos dscp-remap command is used to configure the DSCP to DSCP mappings. To return to the default configuration, please use no qos dscp-remap command. When DSCP remap is configured, the packets with Syntax the specific DSCP priority will be changed to the desired new DSCP priority. qos queue dscp-map { dscp-value-list } { dscp-remap-value } no qos queue dscp-map Parameter Dscp-value-list ——The original DSCP value list in the format of “1-3,5,7”. The valid values are from 0 to 63. Dscp-remap-value—— The new DSCP value, which ranges from 0 to 63. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Map DSCP values 10-12 to DSCP value 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# qos dscp-remap 10-12 2 28.7 qos queue mode Description The qos queue mode command is used to configure the Scheduler Mode. When the network is congested, the program that many packets complete for resources must be solved, usually in the way of queue scheduling. The switch will control the forwarding sequence of the packets according to the priority 256 queues and scheduling algorithms you set. On this switch, the priority levels Syntax are labeled as TC0, TC1, TC2 … TC7. qos queue { tc-queue } mode { sp | wrr } [ weight weight ] Parameter tc-queue —— The egress queue ID. It ranges from 0 to 7, which represents TC queue from TC0 to TC7 respectively. sp —— Strict-Priority Mode. In this mode, the queue with higher priority will occupy the whole bandwidth. Packets in the queue with lower priority are sent only when the queue with higher priority is empty. wrr —— Weight Round Robin Mode. In this mode, packets in all the queues are sent in order based on the weight value for each queue. If you select this mode, you need to specify the queue weight at the same time. weight —— Configure the weight value of the specified TC queue. When the scheduler mode is specified as WRR, the weight value ranges from 1 to 127. The 8 queues will take up the bandwidth according to their ratio. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the Scheduler Mode of TC1 as WRR and set the queue weight as 10 for port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# qos queue 1 mode wrr weight 10 28.8 show qos cos-map Description The show qos cos-msp command is used to display the 802.1p priority to TC Syntax queue mappings. show qos cos-map 257 Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the 802.1p to queue mappings: T1600G-28TS# show qos cos-map 28.9 show qos dot1p-remap Description The show qos dot1p-remap interface command is used to display the Syntax 802.1p priority to 802.1p priority mappings. show qos dot1p-remap Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the IEEE 802.1P remap configuration: T1600G-28TS# show qos dot1p-remap 28.10 show qos dscp-map Description The show qos dscp-map interface command is used to display the DSCP Syntax priority configuration. show qos dscp-map Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 258 Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the DSCP priority configuration: T1600G-28TS# show qos dscp-map 28.11 show qos dscp-remap Description The show qos dscp-remap interface command is used to display the DSCP Syntax priority to DSCP priority mappingss. show qos dscp-remap Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the DSCP to DSCP mappings: T1600G-28TS# show qos dscp-remap 28.12 show qos port-priority interface Description The show qos port-priority interface command is used to display the port to Syntax 802.1p priority mappings for the ports. show qos port-priority interface [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] Parameter port —— The port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 259 Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the port to 802.1p priority mappings for all the ports: T1600G-28TS# show qos port-priority interface 28.13 show qos trust interface Description The show qos trust interface command is used to display the trust mode of Syntax the ports. show qos trust interface [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] Parameter port —— The port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the trust mode of all the ports: T1600G-28TS# show qos trust interface 28.14 show qos queue interface Description The show qos queue interface command is used to display the scheduler Syntax settings of the ports. show qos queue interface [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] 260 Parameter port —— The port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the scheduler settings of all the ports: T1600G-28TS# show qos queue interface 261 Chapter 29 Bandwidth Control Commands Bandwidth Control functions to control the traffic rate and traffic threshold on each port to ensure network performance. Rate limit functions to limit the ingress/egress traffic rate on each port. Storm Control function allows the switch to monitor broadcast packets, multicast packets and Unknown unicast frames in the network. 29.1 storm-control rate-mode Description The storm-control rate-mode command is used to configure the storm control mode of the interface. To return to the default configuration, please Syntax use no storm-control rate-mode command. storm-control rate-mode { kbps | ratio } no storm-control rate-mode Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. User Guidelines This command should be used along with the storm-control command to enable the storm control function and specify the detailed parameters. Example Set the storm control mode as kbps on port 1/0/5: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# storm-control rate-mode kbps 29.2 storm-control Description The storm-control command is used to enable the broadcast, multicast, or unknown unicast strom control function and to set threshold levels on an 262 interface. To return to the default configuration, please use no storm-control Syntax command. storm-control { broadcast | multicast | unicast } { rate } no storm-control { broadcast | multicast | unicast } Parameter broadcast | multicast | unicast —— Select the mode of the storm control on the interface. rate —— Specify the bandwidth for receiving packets on the port. The specified type of packet traffic exceeding the bandwidth will be processed according to the configuration of storm-control exceed command. For kbps, the rate ranges from 1 to 1000000 kbps. For ratio, the rate ranges from 1 to 100 percent. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. User Guidelines Before you configure the storm-control type as kbps or ratio, pelease ensure that the port is not in pps mode. Example Configure the broadcast storm control rate as 1024 kbps on port 1/0/5: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# storm-control rate-mode kbps T1600G-28TS(config-if)# storm-control broadcast 1024 29.3 storm-control exceed Description The storm-control exceed command is used to configure the action that the Syntax switch will perform when the storm exceeds the defined limit on an interface. storm-control exceed { drop | shutdown } [ revocer-time time ] 263 Parameter drop —— Set the Action as Drop. The port will drop the subsequent packets when the traffic exceeds the limit. shutdown —— Set the Action as Shutdown. The port will be shutdown when the traffic exceeds the limit. time ——Specify the recover time for the port. It takes effect only when the action is set as shutdown. The valid values are from 0 to 3600 and the default value is 0. When the port is shutdown, it can recover to its normal state after the recover time passed. If the recover time is specified as 0, which means the port will not recover to its normal state automatically and you can recover the port manually using storm-control recover command. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the action as drop on port 1/0/5: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# storm-control exceed drop 29.4 storm-control recover Description The storm-control recover command is used to recover the port manually after the port is shutdown because of the storm. When the recover time is specified as 0, the port will not recover to its normal state automatically. In Syntax this condition, you need to use this command to recover the port manually. storm-control recover Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) 264 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Recover port 1/0/5 manually: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# storm-control recover 29.5 bandwidth Description The bandwidth command is used to configure the bandwidth limit for an Ethernet port. To disable the bandwidth limit, please use no bandwidth Syntax command. bandwidth {[ ingress ingress-rate ] [ egress egress-rate ]} no bandwidth { all | ingress | egress } Parameter ingress-rate —— Specify the bandwidth for receiving packets. Range: 1-1000000Kbps for the gigaport. egress-rate —— Specify the bandwidth for sending packets. Range: 1-1000000Kbps for the gigaport. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the ingress-rate as 5120Kbps and egress-rate as 1024Kbps for port 1/0/5: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# bandwidth ingress 5120 egress 1024 265 29.6 show storm-control Description The show storm-control command is used to display the storm-control Syntax information of Ethernet ports. show storm-control interface [ fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port-list ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id-list ] Parameter port-list ——The list of Ethernet ports. port-channel-id-list —— The list of port channels. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the storm-control information of port 4, 5, 6, and 7: T1600G-28TS(config)# show storm-control interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/4-7 29.7 show bandwidth Description The show bandwidth command is used to display the bandwidth-limit Syntax information of Ethernet ports. show bandwidth interface [ fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port-list ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id-list ] Parameter port-list ——The list of Ethernet ports. port-channel-id-list —— The list of port channels. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 266 Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the bandwidth-limit information of port 1/0/4: T1600G-28TS(config)# show bandwidth interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/4 267 Chapter 30 Voice VLAN Commands Voice VLANs are configured specially for voice data stream. By configuring Voice VLANs and adding the ports with voice devices attached to voice VLANs, you can perform QoS-related configuration for voice data, ensuring the transmission priority of voice data stream and voice quality. 30.1 voice vlan Description The voice vlan command is used to enable Voice VLAN function. To disable Voice VLAN function, please use no voice vlan command. Syntax voice vlan vlan-id no voice vlan Parameter vlan-id —— Specify IEEE 802.1Q VLAN ID, ranging from 2 to 4094. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the Voice VLAN function for VLAN 10: T1600G-28TS(config)# voice vlan 10 30.2 voice vlan (interface) Description The voice vlan command is used to enable Voice VLAN function on the desired ports. To disable Voice VLAN function on ports, please use no voice vlan command. 268 Syntax voice vlan no voice vlan Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the Voice VLAN function for port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#voice vlan 30.3 voice vlan priority Description The voice vlan priority command is used to configure the priority for the Voice VLAN. To restore to the default priority, please use no voice vlan priority command. Syntax voice vlan priority pri no voice vlan priority Parameter pri —— Priority, ranging from 0 to 7, and the default value is 7. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 269 Example Configure the priority of the Voice VLAN as 5: T1600G-28TS(config)# voice vlan priority 5 30.4 voice vlan oui Description The voice vlan oui command is used to create Voice VLAN OUI. To delete the specified Voice VLAN OUI, please use no voice vlan oui command. Syntax voice vlan oui oui-prefix oui-desc string no voice vlan mac-address oui-prefix Parameter oui-prefix —— The OUI address of the voice device, in the format of XX:XX:XX. string —— Give a description to the OUI for identification which contains 16 characters at most. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create a Voice VLAN OUI described as TP-Phone with the OUI address 00:11:11:11:11:11 and the mask address FF:FF:FF:00:00:00: T1600G-28TS(config)#voice vlan oui 00:11:11 oui-desc TP-Phone 30.5 show voice vlan Description The show voice vlan command is used to display the global configuration information of Voice VLAN. 270 Syntax show voice vlan Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Display the configuration information of Voice VLAN globally: T1600G-28TS(config)# show voice vlan 30.6 show voice vlan oui-table Description The show voice vlan oui command is used to display the configuration information of Voice VLAN OUI. Syntax show voice vlan oui Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Display the configuration information of Voice VLAN OUI: T1600G-28TS(config)# show voice vlan oui-table 30.7 show voice vlan interface Description The show voice vlan interface command is used to display the Voice VLAN configuration information of all ports. 271 Syntax show voice vlan interface Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Display the Voice VLAN configuration information of all ports and port channels: T1600G-28TS(config)# show voice vlan interface 272 Chapter 31 Auto VoIP Commands The Auto VoIP feature is used to prioritize the transmission of voice traffic. Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP) enables telephone calls over a data network, and the Auto VoIP feature helps provide a classification mechanism for voice packets. When Auto VoIP is configured on a port that receives both voice and data traffic, this feature can help ensure that the sound quality of an IP phone does not deteriorate when data traffic on the port is heavy. 31.1 auto-voip Description The auto-voip command is used to enable the Auto VoIP function globally. To disable the Auto VoIP function, use no auto-voip command. Syntax auto-voip no auto-voip Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Example Enable the Auto VoIP function globally: T1600G-28TS(config)# auto-voip 31.2 auto-voip (interface) Description The auto-voip command is used to specify the interface mode as VLAN ID for the ports. In this mode, the voice devices will send voice packets with desired VLAN tag. Syntax auto-voip vlan-id Parameter vlan-id ——Specify the Auto VoIP VLAN ID. The valid values are from 2 to 4094. 273 Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Example Set Auto VoIP VLAN 3 for port 3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# auto-voip 3 31.3 auto-voip dot1p Description The auto-voip dot1p command is used to specify the interface mode as dat1p for the ports. In this mode, the voice devices will send voice packets with desired 802.1p priority. Syntax auto-voip dot1p dot1p Parameter dot1p——Set the 802.1p priority of Auto VoIP on specified ports. It ranges from 0 to 7. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Example Set the 802.1p priority as 5 for the port: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# auto-voip dot1p 5 274 31.4 auto-voip untagged Description The auto-voip untagged command is used to specify the interface mode as untagged for the ports. In this mode, the voice devices will send untagged voice packets. Syntax auto-voip untagged Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Example Set the interface mode as untagged for port 1/0/3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# auto-voip untagged 31.5 auto-voip none Description The auto-voip none command is used to specify the interface mode as none for the ports. In this mode, the switch allows the voice devices to use its own configuration to send voice traffic. Syntax auto-voip none Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Example Instruct voice devices that are connected to port 3 to send the packets according to its own configuration: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# auto-voip none 275 31.6 no auto-voip (interface) Description The no auto-voip command is used to specify the interface mode as disabled for the ports, which means the Auto VoIP function is disabled on the corresponding port. Syntax no auto-voip Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Example Disable the Auto VoIP function on port 1/0/3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no auto-voip 31.7 auto-voip dscp Description The auto-voip dscp command is used to set the DSCP value of Auto VoIP on specified ports. Syntax auto-voip dscp value Parameter value——Set the DSCP value of Auto VoIP on specified ports. It ranges from 0 to 63. By default, it is 0. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Example Set DSCP value of Auto VoIP on port 3 as 33: 276 T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# auto-voip dscp 33 31.8 auto-voip data priority Description The auto-voip data priority command is used to enable or disable the CoS Override Mode on specified ports. Syntax auto-voip data priority { trust | untrust } Parameter trust——In this mode, the switch will then put the voice packets in the corresponding TC queue according to the 802.1p priority of the packets. untrust——In this mode, the switch will ignore the 802.1p priority in the voice packets and put the packets in TC-5 directly. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Example Set the CoS Override Mode as trust for port 1/0/3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# auto-voip data priority trust 31.9 show auto-voip Description The show auto-voip command is used to display the Auto VoIP configuration information. Syntax show auto-voip [ interface ] 277 Parameter interface —— Displays the Auto VoIP configuration information of ports. When no parameter is entered, displays the global Auto VoIP configuration information. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and any Configuration Mode Example Displays the global Auto VoIP configuration information: T1600G-28TS (config)# show auto-voip 278 Chapter 32 Access Control Commands 32.1 user access-control ip-based enable Description The user access-control ip-based enable command is used to configure the access control mode IP-based. To disable the access control feature, please use no user access-control command. Syntax user access-control ip-based enable no user access-control Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the access control mode as IP-based: T1600G-28TS(config)# user access-control ip-based enable 32.2 user access-control ip-based Description The user access-control ip-based command is used to limit the IP-range of the users for login. Only the users within the IP-range you set here are allowed to login. You can add up to 30 IP-based entries. To cancel the user access limit, please use no user access-control ip-based command. Syntax user access-control ip-based { ip-addr ip-mask } [ snmp ] [ telnet ] [ ssh ] [ http ] [ https ] [ ping ] [ all ] no user access-control ip-based index id 279 Parameter ip-addr —— The source IP address. Only the users within the IP-range you set here are allowed for login. 5 IP-based entries can be configured at most. ip-mask —— The subnet mask of the IP address. [ snmp ] [ telnet ] [ ssh ] [ http ] [ https ] [ ping ] [ all ] —— Specify the access interface. These interfaces are enabled by default. id —— Delete the specified IP-based entry. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the access-control of the user whose IP address is 192.168.0.148: T1600G-28TS(config)# user access-control ip-based 192.168.0.148 255.255.255.255 32.3 user access-control mac-based enable Description The user access-control mac-based enable command is used to configure the access control mode MAC-based. To disable the access control feature, please use no user access-control command. Syntax user access-control mac-based enable no user access-control Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. 280 Example Configure the access control mode as MAC-based: T1600G-28TS(config)# user access-control mac-based enable 32.4 user access-control mac-based Description The user access-control mac-based command is used to limit the MAC address of the users for login. Only the user with this MAC address you set here is allowed to login. You can add up to 30 mac-based control entries. To delete the mac-based access control entry, please use no user access-control mac-based command. Syntax user access-control mac-based { mac-addr } [ snmp ] [ telnet ] [ ssh ] [ http ] [ https ] [ ping ] [ all ] no user access-control mac-based index id Parameter mac-addr —— The source MAC address. Only the user with this MAC address is allowed to login. [ snmp ] [ telnet ] [ ssh ] [ http ] [ https ] [ ping ] [ all ] —— Specify the access interface. These interfaces are enabled by default. id—— Specify the ID of the mac-based entry to be deleted. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure that only the user whose MAC address is 00:00:13:0A:00:01 is allowed to login: T1600G-28TS(config)# user access-control mac-based 00:00:13:0A:00:01 281 32.5 user access-control port-based enable Description The user access-control port-based enable command is used to configure the access control mode Port-based. To disable the access control feature, please use no user access-control command. Syntax user access-control port-based enable no user access-control Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the access control mode as Port-based: T1600G-28TS(config)# user access-control port-based enable 32.6 user access-control port-based Description The user access-control port-based command is used to limit the ports for login. Only the users connected to these ports you set here are allowed to login. You can add up to 30 port-based control entries. To delete the port-based access control entry, please use no user access-control port-based command. Syntax user access-control port-based interface { gigabitEthernet port-list } [ snmp ] [ telnet ] [ ssh ] [ http ] [ https ] [ ping ] [ all ] no user access-control port-based index id Parameter port-list ——The list group of Ethernet ports, in the format of 1/0/1-4. You can appoint 5 ports at most. 282 [ snmp ] [ telnet ] [ ssh ] [ http ] [ https ] [ ping ] [ all ] —— Specify the access interface. These interfaces are enabled by default. id—— Specify the ID of the port-based entry to be deleted. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure that only the users connected to ports 2-6 are allowed to login: T1600G-28TS(config)# user gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-6 283 access-control port-based interface Chapter 33 HTTP and HTTPS Commands With the help of HTTP (HyperText Transfer Protocol) or HTTPS (Hyper Text Transfer Protocol over Secure Socket Layer), you can manage the switch through a standard browser. HTTP is the protocol to exchange or transfer hypertext. SSL (Secure Sockets Layer), a security protocol, is to provide a secure connection for the application layer protocol (e.g. HTTP) based on TCP. Adopting asymmetrical encryption technology, SSL uses key pair to encrypt/decrypt information. A key pair refers to a public key (contained in the certificate) and its corresponding private key. By default the switch has a certificate (self-signed certificate) and a corresponding private key. The Certificate/Key Download function enables the user to replace the default key pair. 33.1 ip http server Description The ip http server command is used to enable the HTTP server within the switch. To disable the HTTP function, please use no ip http server command. This function is enabled by default. The HTTP and HTTPS server function cannot be disabled at the same time. Syntax ip http server no ip http server Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Disable the HTTP function: T1600G-28TS(config)# no ip http server 33.2 ip http port Description 284 The ip http port command is used to configure the port number of the HTTP server within the switch. To set the number to the default value, please use no ip http port command. Syntax ip http port port-num no ip http port Parameter port-num —— Enter the port number. This value ranges from 1 to 65535. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Set the port number of HTTP server as 1800: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http port 1800 33.3 ip http max-users Description The ip http max-users command is used to configure the maximum number of users that are allowed to connect to the HTTP server. To cancel this limitation, please use no ip http max-users command. Syntax ip http max-users admin-num operator-num poweruser-num user-num no ip http max-users Parameter admin-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the HTTP server as Admin, ranging from 1 to 16. The total number of users should be no more than 16. operator-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the HTTP server as operator, ranging from 0 to 15. The total number of users should be no more than 16. 285 poweruser-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the HTTP server as Power User, ranging from 0 to 15. The total number of users should be no more than 16. user-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the HTTP server as User, ranging from 0 to 15. The total number of users should be no more than 16. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the maximum number of the Admin, Operator, Power User and User as 5, 1, 1, 1 for HTTP: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http max-users 5 1 1 1 33.4 ip http session timeout Description The ip http session timeout command is used to configure the connection timeout of the HTTP server. To restore to the default timeout time, please use no ip http session timeout command. Syntax ip http session timeout time no ip http session timeout Parameter time ——The timeout time, ranging from 5 to 30 in minutes. By default, the value is 10. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example 286 Configure the timeout time of the HTTP connection as 15 minutes: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http session timeout 15 33.5 ip http secure-server Description The ip http secure-server command is used to enable the HTTPS server within the switch. To disable the HTTPS function, please use no ip http secure-server command. This function is enabled by default. The HTTP and HTTPS server function cannot be disabled at the same time. Syntax ip http secure-server no ip http secure-server Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Disable the HTTP function: T1600G-28TS(config)# no ip http secure-server 33.6 ip http secure-port Description The ip http secure-port command is used to configure the port number of the HTTPS server within the switch. To set the number to the default value, please use no ip http secure-port command. Syntax ip http secure-port port-num no ip http secure-port Parameter port-num —— Enter the port number. This value ranges from 1 to 65535. 287 Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Set the port number of HTTPS server as 2800: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http port 2800 33.7 ip http secure-protocol Description The ip http secure-protocol command is used to configure the SSL protocol version. To restore to the default SSL version, please use no ip http secure-protocol command. By default, the switch supports SSLv3 and TLSv1. Syntax ip http secure-protocol { [ ssl3 ] [ tls1 ] } no ip http session Parameter ssl3 —— The SSL 3.0 protocol. tls1 —— The TLS 1.0 protocol Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the protocol of SSL connection as SSL 3.0: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-protocol ssl3 288 33.8 ip http secure-ciphersuite Description The ip http secure-ciphersuite command is used to configure the cipherSuites over the SSL connection supported by the switch. To restore to the default ciphersuite types, please use no ip http secure-ciphersuite command. Syntax ip http secure-ciphersuite { [ 3des-ede-cbc-sha ] [ rc4-128-md5 ] [ rc4-128-sha ] [ des-cbc-sha ] } no ip http secure-ciphersuite Parameter [ 3des-ede-cbc-sha ] [ rc4-128-md5 ] [ rc4-128-sha ] [ des-cbc-sha ] —— Specify the encryption algorithm and the digest algorithm to use on an SSL connection. By default, the switch supports all these ciphersuites. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the ciphersuite to be used for encryption over the SSL connection as 3des-ede-cbc-sha: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-ciphersuite 3des-ede-cbc-sha 33.9 ip http secure-max-users Description The ip http secure-max-users command is used to configure the maximum number of users that are allowed to connect to the HTTPs server. To cancel this limitation, please use no ip http secure-max-users command. Syntax 289 ip http secure-max-users admin-num operator-num poweruser-num user-num no ip secure-max-users Parameter admin-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the HTTPs server as Admin, ranging from 1 to 16. The total number of users should be less than 16. Operator-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the HTTPs server as operator, ranging from 0 to 15. The total number of users should be less than 16. poweruser-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the HTTP server as Power User, ranging from 0 to 15. The total number of users should be less than 16. user-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the HTTP server as User, ranging from 0 to 15. The total number of users should be less than 16. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the maximum number of the Admin, Operator, Power User and User as 5, 1, 1, 1 for HTTPs: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-max-users 5 1 1 1 33.10 ip http secure-session timeout Description The ip http secure-session timeout command is used to configure the connection timeout of the HTTPS server. To restore to the default timeout time, please use no ip http secure-session timeout command. Syntax ip http secure-session timeout time 290 no ip http secure-session timeout Parameter time —— The timeout time, ranging from 5 to 30 in minutes. By default, the value is 10. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the timeout time of the HTTPs connection as 15 minutes: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-session timeout 15 33.11 ip http secure-server download certificate Description The ip http secure-server download certificate command is used to download a certificate to the switch from TFTP server. Syntax ip http secure-server download certificate ssl-cert ip-address ip-addr Parameter ssl-cert —— The name of the SSL certificate which is selected to download to the switch. The length of the name ranges from 1 to 25 characters. The Certificate must be BASE64 encoded. ip-addr —— The IP address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example 291 Download an SSL Certificate named ssl-cert from TFTP server with the IP address of 192.168.0.146: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-server download certificate ssl-cert ip-address 192.168.0.146 Download an SSL Certificate named ssl-cert from TFTP server with the IP address of fe80::1234 T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-server download certificate ssl-cert ip-address fe80::1234 33.12 ip http secure-server download key Description The ip http secure-server download key command is used to download an SSL key to the switch from TFTP server. Syntax ip http secure-server download key ssl-key ip-address ip-addr Parameter ssl-key —— The name of the SSL key which is selected to download to the switch. The length of the name ranges from 1 to 25 characters. The Key must be BASE64 encoded. ip-addr —— The IP address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Download an SSL key named ssl-key from TFTP server with the IP address of 192.168.0.146: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-server download key ssl-key ip-address 192.168.0.146 292 Download an SSL key named ssl-key from TFTP server with the IP address of fe80::1234 T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-server download key ssl-key ip-address fe80::1234 33.13 show ip http configuration Description The show ip http configuration command is used to display the configuration information of the HTTP server, including status, session timeout, access-control, max-user number and the idle-timeout, etc. Syntax show ip http configuration Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configuration information of the HTTP server: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip http configuration 33.14 show ip http secure-server Description The show ip http secure-server command is used to display the global configuration of SSL. Syntax show ip http secure-server Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. 293 Example Display the global configuration of SSL: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip http secure-server 294 Chapter 34 SSH Commands SSH (Security Shell) can provide the unsecured remote management with security and powerful authentication to ensure the security of the management information. 34.1 ip ssh server Description The ip ssh server command is used to enable SSH function. To disable the SSH function, please use no ip ssh server command. Syntax ip ssh server no ip ssh server Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the SSH function: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip ssh server 34.2 ip ssh port Description The ip ssh port command is used to configure the port for SSH service. To set the value to the default, please use no ip ssh port command. Syntax ip ssh port port no ip ssh port 295 Parameter port —— Set the port number. It ranges from 1 to 65535. The default value is 22. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the SSH port number as 22: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip ssh port 22 34.3 ip ssh version Description The ip ssh version command is used to enable the SSH protocol version. To disable the protocol version, please use no ip ssh version command. Syntax ip ssh version { v1 | v2 } no ip ssh version { v1 | v2 } Parameter v1 | v2 —— The SSH protocol version to be enabled. They represent SSH v1 and SSH v2 respectively. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable SSH v2: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip ssh version v2 296 34.4 ip ssh algorithm Description The ip ssh algorithm command is used to configure the algorithm in SSH function. To disable the specified algorithm, please use no ip ssh algorithm Syntax command. ip ssh algorithm { AES128-CBC | AES192-CBC | AES256-CBC | Blowfish-CBC | Cast128-CBC | 3DES-CBC | HMAC-SHA1 | HMAC-MD5 } no ip ssh algorithm Parameter AES128-CBC | AES192-CBC | AES256-CBC | Blowfish-CBC | Cast128-CBC | 3DES-CBC | HMAC-SHA1 | HMAC-MD5 —— Specify the SSH algorithm. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the SSH algorithm as AES128-CBC: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip ssh algorithm AES128-CBC 34.5 ip ssh timeout Description The ip ssh timeout command is used to specify the idle-timeout time of SSH. To restore to the factory defaults, please use ip ssh timeout command. Syntax ip ssh timeout value no ip ssh timeout Parameter value —— The Idle-timeout time. During this period, the system will automatically release the connection if there is no 297 operation from the client. It ranges from 1 to 120 in seconds. By default, this value is 120 seconds. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the idle-timeout time of SSH as 30 seconds: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip ssh timeout 30 34.6 ip ssh max-client Description The ip ssh max-client command is used to specify the maximum number of the connections to the SSH server. To return to the default configuration, please use no ip ssh max-client command. Syntax ip ssh max-client num no ip ssh max-client Parameter num —— The maximum number of the connections to the SSH server. It ranges from 1 to 5. By default, this value is 5. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the maximum number of the connections to the SSH server as 3: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip ssh max-client 3 298 34.7 ip ssh download Description The ip ssh download command is used to download the SSH key file from Syntax TFTP server. ip ssh download { v1 | v2 } key-file ip-address ip-addr Parameter v1 | v2 —— Select the type of SSH key to download, v1 represents SSH-1, v2 represents SSH-2. key-file —— The name of the key-file which is selected to download. The length of the name ranges from 1 to 25 characters. The key length of the downloaded file must be in the range of 512 to 3072 bits. ip-addr —— The IP address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Download an SSH-1 type key file named ssh-key from TFTP server with the IP address 192.168.0.148: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip ssh download v1 ssh-key ip-address 192.168.0.148 Download an SSH-1 type key file named ssh-key from TFTP server with the IP address fe80::1234: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip ssh download v1 ssh-key ip-address fe80::1234 34.8 remove public-key Description The remove public-key command is used to remove the SSH public key from the switch. 299 Syntax remove public-key { v1 | v2 } Parameter v1 | v2 —— Select the type of SSH public key, v1 represents SSH-1, v2 represents SSH-2. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Remove the SSH-1 type public key from the switch: T1600G-28TS# remove public-key v1 34.9 show ip ssh Description Syntax The show ip ssh command is used to display the global configuration of SSH. show ip ssh Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the global configuration of SSH: T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip ssh 300 Chapter 35 Telnet Commands 35.1 telnet enable Description The telnet enable command is used to enable the Telnet function. To disable the Telnet function, please use the telnet disable command. This function is enabled by default. Syntax telnet enable telnet disable Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Disable the Telnet function: T1600G-28TS(config)# telnet disable 35.2 telnet port Description The telnet port command is used to configure the telent port number. To restore the setting, please use the no telnet port command. Syntax telnet port port no telnet port Parameter port——The number of telnet port. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode 301 Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the telnet port number as 566: T1600G-28TS(config)# telnet port 566 35.3 show telnet-status Description The show telnet-status command is used to display the configuration information of the Telnet function. Syntax show telnet-status Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display whether the Telnet function is enabled: T1600G-28TS(config)# show telnet-status 302 Chapter 36 AAA Commands AAA stands for authentication, authorization and accounting. This feature is used to authenticate users trying to log in to the switch or trying to access the administrative level privilege. Applicable Access Application The authentication can be applied on the following access applications: Telnet, SSH and HTTP. Authentication Method List A method list describes the authentication methods and their sequence to authenticate a user. The switch supports Login List for users to gain access to the switch, and Enable List for normal users to gain administrative privileges. RADIUS/TACACS+ Server User can configure the RADIUS/TACACS+ servers for the connection between the switch and the server. Server Group User can define the authentication server group with up to several servers running the same secure protocols, either RADIUS or TACACS+. Users can set these servers in a preferable order, which is called the server group list. When a user tries to access the switch, the switch will ask the first server in the server group list for authentication. If no response is received, the second server will be queried, and so on. 36.1 tacacas-server host Description The tacacs-server host command is used to configure a new TACACS+ server. To delete the specified TACACS+ server, please use no tacacs-server host command. Syntax tacacs-server host ip-address [ port port-id ] [ timeout time ] [ key { [ 0 ] string | 7 encryped-string } ] no tacacs-server host ip-address Parameter ip-address —— Specify the IP address of the TACACS+ server. port-id —— Specify the server’s port number for AAA. By default it is 49. 303 time —— Specify the time in seconds the switch waits for the server’s response before it times out. The time ranges from 1 to 9 seconds. The default is 5 seconds. [ 0 ] string | 7 encrypted-string —— 0 and 7 are the encryption type. 0 indicates that an unencrypted key will follow. 7 indicates that a symmetric encrypted key with a fixed length will follow. By default, the encryption type is 0. “string” is the shared key for the switch and the authentication servers to exchange messages which contains 32 characters at most. The question marks and spaces are not allowed. “encrypted-string” is a symmetric encrypted key with a fixed length, which you can copy from another switch’s configuration file. The key or encrypted-key you configured here will be displayed in the encrypted form. Always configure the key as the last item of this command. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. User Guidelines The TACACS+ servers you configured are added in the server group “tacacs” by default. Example Configure a TACACS+ server with the IP address as 1.1.1.1, TCP port as 1500, timeout as 6 seconds, and the unencrypted key string as 12345. T1600G-28TS(config)# tacacs-server host 1.1.1.1 port 1500 timeout 6 key 12345 36.2 show tacacs-server Description This show tacacs-server command is used to display the summary information of the TACACS+ servers. Syntax show tacacs-server 304 Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the information of all the TACACS+ servers: T1600G-28TS(config)# show tacacs-server 36.3 radius-server host Description The radius-server host command is used to configure a new RADIUS server. To delete the specified RADIUS server, please use no radius-server host command. Syntax radius-server host ip-address [ auth-port port-id ] [ acct-port port-id ] [ timeout time ] [ retransmit number ] [ nas-id nas-id ] encrypted-string } ] [ key { [ 0 ] string | 7 no radius-server host ip-address Parameter ip-address —— Specify the IP address of the RADIUS server. auth-port port-id —— Specify the UDP destination port for authentication requests. By default it is 1812. acct-port port-id —— Specify the UDP destination port for accouting requests. By deault it is 1813. time —— Specify the time in seconds the switch waits for the server’s response before it times out. The time ranges from 1 to 9 seconds. The default is 5 seconds. number —— Specify the number of times a RADIUS request is resent to a server if the server is not responding in time. By default it is 2 times. nas-id ——Specify the name of the NAS (Network Access Server) to be contained in RADIUS packets for identification. It ranges from 1 to 31 characters. The default value is the MAC address of the switch. Generally, the NAS indicates the switch itself. 305 [ 0 ] string | 7 encrypted-string —— 0 and 7 are the encryption type. 0 indicates that an unencrypted key will follow. 7 indicates that a symmetric encrypted key with a fixed length will follow. By default, the encryption type is 0. “string” is the shared key for the switch and the authentication servers to exchange messages which contains 32 characters at most. The question marks and spaces are not allowed. “encrypted-string” is a symmetric encrypted key with a fixed length, which you can copy from another switch’s configuration file. The key or encrypted-key you configured here will be displayed in the encrypted form. Always configure the key as the last item of this command. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. User Guidelines The RADIUS servers you configured are added in the server group “radius” by default. Example Configure a RADIUS server with the IP address as 1.1.1.1, authentication port as 1200, timeout as 6 seconds, retransmit times as 3, and the unencrypted key string as 12345. T1600G-28TS(config)# radius-server host 1.1.1.1 auth-port 1200 timeout 6 retransmit 3 key 12345 36.4 show radius-server Description This show radius-server command is used to display the summary information of the RADIUS servers. Syntax show radius-server Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 306 Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the information of all the RADIUS servers: T1600G-28TS(config)# show radius-server 36.5 aaa group Description This aaa group command is used to create AAA server groups to group existing TACACS+/RADIUS servers for authentication. This command puts the switch in the server group subconfiguration mode. To delete the corresponding AAA group, please use the no aaa group command. Syntax aaa group { radius | tacacs } group-name no aaa group { radius | tacacs } group-name Parameter radius | tacacs —— Specify the server group type as RADIUS or TACACS+. group-name —— Specify the server group name. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Create a RADIUS server group with the name radius1: T1600G-28TS(config)# aaa group radius radius1 307 36.6 server Description This server command is used to add the existing server in the defined server group. To remove the specified server from the server group, please use the no server command. Syntax server ip-address no server ip-address Parameter ip-address —— Specify the server’s IP address. Command Mode Server Group Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Create the RADIUS server 1.1.1.1 to RADIUS server group “radius1”: T1600G-28TS(config)# aaa group radius radius1 T1600G-28TS(aaa-group)# server 1.1.1.1 36.7 show aaa group Description This show aaa group command is used to display the summary information of the AAA groups. All the servers in this group will be listed if you specify the group name. Syntax show aaa group [ group-name ] Parameter group-name —— Specify the server group name. 308 Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the information of all the server groups: T1600G-28TS(config)# show aaa group 36.8 aaa authentication login Description This aaa authentication login command is used to configure a login authentication method list. A method list describes the authentication methods and their sequence to authenticate a user. To delete the specified authentication method list, please use the no aaa authentication login command. Syntax aaa authentication login { method-list } { method1 } [ method2 ] [ method3 ] [ method4 ] no authentication login method-list Parameter method-list —— Specify the method list name. method1, method2, method3, method4 —— Specify the authentication methods in order. The next authentication method is tried only if the previous method does not respond, not if it fails. The preset methods include radius, tacacs, local and none. “radius” means the RADIUS server group “radius”; “tacacs” means the RACACS+ server group “tacacs”; “local” means local username database are used; “none” means no authentication is used for login. Users can aslo define new method with the aaa group command. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode 309 Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. User Guidelines By default the login authentication method list is “default” with “local” as method1. Example Configure a login authentication method list “list1” with the priority1 method as radius and priority2 method as local: T1600G-28TS(config)# aaa authenticaiton login list1 radius local 36.9 aaa authentication enable Description This aaa authentication enable command is used to configure a privilege authentication method list. A method list describes the authentication methods and their sequence to elevate a user’s privilege. To delete the specified authentication method list, please use the no aaa authentication enable command. Syntax aaa authentication enable { method-list } { method1 } [ method2 ] [ method3 ] [ method4 ] no authentication enable method-list Parameter method-list —— Specify the method list name. method1, method2, method3, method4 —— Specify the authentication methods in order. The next authentication method is tried only if the previous method does not respond, not if it fails. The preset methods include radius, tacacs, local and none. “radius” means the RADIUS server group “radius”; “tacacs” means the RACACS+ server group “tacacs”; “local” means local username database are used; “none” means no authentication is used for privilege elevation. Users can aslo define new method with the aaa group command. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode 310 Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. User Guidelines By default the enable authentication method is “default” with “none” as method1. Example Configure a privilege authentication method list “list2” with the priority1 method as radius and priority2 method as local: T1600G-28TS(config)# aaa authenticaiton enable list2 radius local 36.10 aaa authentication dot1x default Description This aaa authentication dot1x default command is used to configure an 802.1x authentication method list. A method list describes the authentication methods for users’ login in 802.1x. To delete the default authentication method list, please use the no aaa authentication dot1x default command. Syntax aaa authentication dot1x default { method } no aaa authentication dot1x default Parameter method —— Specify the method name. Only RADIUS server group is supported, and the default method is server group “radius”. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the default 802.1x authentication method as “radius1”: T1600G-28TS(config)# aaa authentication dot1x default radius1 311 36.11 aaa accounting dot1x default Description This aaa accounting dot1x default command is used to configure an 802.1x accounting method list. To delete the default accounting method list, please use the no aaa accounting dot1x default command. Syntax aaa accounting dot1x default { method } no aaa accounting dot1x default Parameter method —— Sp+ecify the method name. Only RADIUS server group is supported, and the default method is server group “radius”. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the default 802.1x accounting method as “radius1”: T1600G-28TS(config)# aaa accounting dot1x default radius1 36.12 show aaa authentication Description This show aaa authentication command is used to display the summary information of the authentication login, enable and dot1x metheod list. Syntax show aaa authentication [ login | enable | dot1x ] Parameter login | enable | dot1x —— Specify the method list type. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 312 Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the information of all the authentication method lists: T1600G-28TS(config)# show aaa authentication 36.13 show aaa accounting Description This show aaa accounting command is used to display the summary information of the accounting metheod list. Syntax show aaa accounting [ dot1x ] Parameter dot1x —— Specify the method list type. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the information of the default 802.1x accounting method list: T1600G-28TS(config)# show aaa accounting 36.14 line telnet Description The line telnet command is used to enter the Line Configuration Mode to configure the telnet terminal line to which you want to apply the authentication list. Syntax line telnet 313 Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Enter the telnet terminal line configuration mode: T1600G-28TS(config)#line telnet 36.15 login authentication (telnet) Description The login authentication command is used to apply the login authentication method list to the telnet terminal line. To restore to the default authentication method list, please use the no login authentication command. Syntax login authentication { method-list } no login authentication Parameter method-list —— Specify the login method list on the telnet terminal line. It is “default” by default, which contains the method “local”. Command Mode Line Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the login authentication method list on the telnet terminal line as “list1”: T1600G-28TS(config)#line telnet T1600G-28TS(config-line)# login authentication list1 314 36.16 line ssh Description The line ssh command is used to enter the Line Configuration Mode to configure the ssh terminal line to which you want to apply the authentication list. Syntax line ssh Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Enter the ssh terminal line configuration mode: T1600G-28TS(config)#line ssh 36.17 login authentication (ssh) Description The login authentication command is used to apply the login authentication method list to the ssh terminal line. To restore to the default authentication method list, please use the no login authentication command. Syntax login authentication { method-list } no login authentication Parameter method-list —— Specify the login method list on the ssh terminal line. It is “default” by default, which contains the method “local”. Command Mode Line Configuration Mode 315 Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the login authentication method list on the ssh terminal line as “list1”: T1600G-28TS(config)# line ssh T1600G-28TS(config-line)# login authentication list1 36.18 enable authentication (telnet) Description The enable authentication command is used to apply the privilege authentication method list to the telnet terminal line. To restore to the default authentication method list, please use the no enable authentication command. Syntax enable authentication { method-list } no enable authentication Parameter method-list —— Specify the enable method list on the telnet terminal line. It is “default” by default, which contains the method “none”. Command Mode Line Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the enable authentication method list on the telnet terminal line as “list2”: T1600G-28TS(config)#line telnet T1600G-28TS(config-line)# enable authentication list2 316 36.19 enable authentication (ssh) Description The enable authentication command is used to apply the privilege authentication method list to the ssh terminal line. To restore to the default authentication method list, please use the no enable authentication command. Syntax enable authentication { method-list } no enable authentication Parameter method-list —— Specify the enable method list on the ssh terminal line. It is “default” by default, which contains the method “none”. Command Mode Line Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the enable authentication method list on the ssh terminal line as “list2”: T1600G-28TS(config)# line ssh T1600G-28TS(config-line)# enable authentication list2 36.20 ip http login authentication Description The ip http login authentication command is used to apply the login authentication method list to users accessing through HTTP. To restore to the default authentication method list, please use the no ip http login authentication command. Syntax ip http login authentication { method-list } 317 no ip http login authentication Parameter method-list —— Specify the login method list on the HTTP access. It is “default” by default, which contains the method “local”. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the login authentication method list on the HTTP access as “list1”: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http login authentication list1 36.21 ip http enable authentication Description The ip http enable authentication command is used to apply the privilege authentication method list to users accessing through HTTP. To restore to the default authentication method list, please use the no ip http enable authentication command. Syntax ip http enable authentication { method-list } no ip http enable authentication Parameter method-list —— Specify the enable method list on the HTTP access. It is “default” by default, which contains the method “none”. Command Mode Line Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. 318 Example Configure the enable authentication method list on the HTTP access as “list2”: T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http enable authentication list2 36.22 show aaa global Description This show aaa global command is used to display global status of AAA function and the login/enable method lists of different application modules: telnet, ssh and HTTP. Syntax show aaa global Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the AAA function’s global status and each application’s method list: T1600G-28TS(config)# show aaa global 36.23 enable-admin Description The enable-admin command is used to get the administrative privelges by a non-admin user. Syntax enable-admin Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode 319 Privilege Requirement Only User, Power User and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Get the administrative privelges (the Enable password is “123456”): T1600G-28TS# enable-admin Password: 123456 320 Chapter 37 IEEE 802.1x Commands IEEE 802.1x function is to provide an access control for LAN ports via the authentication. An 802.1x system include three entities: supplicant, authenticator and authentication server. Supplicant: the device that requests access to the LAN. Authentication server: performs the actual authentication of the supplicant. It validates the identity of the supplicant and notifies the authenticator whether or not the supplicant is authorized to access the LAN. Authenticator: controls the physical access to the network based on the authentication status of the supplicant. It is usually an 802.1x-supported network device, such as this TP-Link switch. It acts as an intermediary (proxy) between the supplicant and the authentication server, requesting identity information from the supplicant, verifying that information with the authentication server, and relaying a response to the supplicant. This chapter handles with the authentication process between the supplicant and the switch. To realize the authentication and accounting function, you should also enbable the AAA function and configure the RADIUS server. Go to Chapter 42 AAA Commands for more details. 37.1 dot1x system-auth-control Description The dot1x system-auth-control command is used to enable the IEEE 802.1x function globally. To disable the IEEE 802.1x function, please use no dot1x system-auth-control command. Syntax dot1x system-auth-control no dot1x system-auth-control Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the IEEE 802.1x function: T1600G-28TS(config)#dot1x system-auth-control 321 37.2 dot1x handshake Description The dot1x handshake command is used enable the handshake feature. The handshake feature is used to detect the connection status between the TP-Link 802.1x supplicant and the switch. Please disable the handshake feature if you are using a non-TP-Link 802.1x-compliant client software. This feature is enabled by default. Syntax dot1x handshake no dot1x handshake Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Disable the 802.1x handshake function: T1600G-28TS(config)# no dot1x handshake 37.3 dot1x auth-protocol Description The dot1x auth-protocol command is used to configure the authentication protocol of IEEE 802.1x and the default 802.1x authentication method is “eap”. To restore to the default 802.1x authentication protocol, please use no dot1x auth-protocol command. Syntax dot1x auth-protocol { pap | eap } no dot1x auth-protocol Parameter pap | eap ——Authentication protocols. 322 pap: EAP termination mode. IEEE 802.1x authentication system uses extensible authentication protocol (EAP) to exchange information between the switch and the client. The EAP packets are terminated at the switch and repackaged in the Password Authentication Protocol (PAP) packets, and then transferred to the RADIUS server. eap: EAP relay mode. IEEE 802.1x authentication system uses extensible authentication protocol (EAP) to exchange information between the switch and the client. The EAP protocol packets with authentication data are encapsulated in the advanced protocol (such as RADIUS) packets and transmitted to the authentication server. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the Authentication protocol of IEEE 802.1x as “pap”: T1600G-28TS(config)#dot1x auth-protocol pap 37.4 dot1x vlan-assignment Description The dot1x vlan-assignment command is used to enable the VLAN assignment feature.To disable this vlan-assignment command. feature, please use no dot1x 802.1x VLAN assignment is a technology allowing the RADIUS server to send the VLAN assignment to the port when the port is authenticated. If the assigned VLAN does not exist on the switch, the switch will create the related VLAN automatically, add the authenticated port to the VLAN and change the PVID based on the assigned VLAN. If the assigned VLAN exists on the switch, the switch will directly add the authenticated port to the related VLAN and change the PVID instead of creating a new VLAN. If no VLAN is supplied by the RADIUS server or if 802.1x authentication is disabled, the port will be in its original VLAN after successful authentication. 323 Syntax dot1x vlan-assignment no dot1x vlan-assignment Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the VLAN assignment feature: T1600G-28TS(config)#dot1x vlan-assignment 37.5 dot1x accounting Description The dot1x accounting command is used to enable the IEEE 802.1x accounting function globally. To disable the IEEE 802.1x accounting function, please use no dot1x accounting command. Syntax dot1x accounting no dot1x accounting Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the enable the IEEE 802.1x accounting function globally: T1600G-28TS(config)#dot1x accounting 324 37.6 dot1x mab Description The dot1x mab command is used to enable the MAB feature on the port.To disable this feature, please use no dot1x mab command. With MAB (MAC-Based Authentication Bypass) feature enabled, the switch automatically sends the authentication server a RADIUS access request frame with the client’s MAC address as the username and password. It is also necessary to configure the RADIUS server with the client’s information for authentication. You can enable this feature on IEEE 802.1x ports connected to devices without 802.1x capability. For example, most printers, IP phones and fax machines do not have 802.1x capability. Syntax dot1x mab no dot1x mab Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the MAB feature on the Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x mab 37.7 dot1x guest-vlan Description The dot1x guest-vlan command is used to configure the Guest VLAN function on the port. To disable the Guest VLAN function, please use no dot1x guest-vlan command. 325 Syntax dot1x guest-vlan vid no dot1x guest-vlan Parameter vid —— The VLAN ID needed to enable the Guest VLAN function, ranging from 0 to 4094. 0 means that Guest VLAN is disabled. The supplicants in the Guest VLAN can access the specified network source. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the Guest VLAN function for VLAN 5 and set the VLAN ID as 20 on the Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1:: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x guest-vlan 5 37.8 dot1x timeout quiet-period Description The dot1x timeout quiet-period command is used to enable the quiet-period function on the port. To disable the function, please use no dot1x timeout quiet-period command. Syntax dot1x timeout quiet-period [ time ] no dot1x timeout quiet-period Parameter time —— The length of the quiet-period time. If one user’s authentication fails, its subsequent IEEE 802.1x authentication requests will not be processed during the quiet-period time. It ranges from 1 to 999 seconds and the default value is 10 seconds. 326 Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the quiet-period function and set the quiet-period as 5 seconds on the Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x quiet-period 5 37.9 dot1x timeout supp-timeout Description The dot1x timeout supp-timeout command is used to configure the supplicant timeout on the port.To restore to the default, please use no dot1x timeout supp-timeout command. Syntax dot1x timeout supp-timeout time no dot1x timeout supp-timeout Parameter time ——The maximum time for the switch to wait for the response from supplicant before resending a request to the supplicant., ranging from 1 to 9 in second. By default, it is 3 seconds. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the supplicant timeout value as 5 seconds on the Gigabit Ethernet pot 1/0/1: 327 T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x timeout supp-timeout 5 37.10 dot1x max- req Description The dot1x max-req command is used to configure the maximum transfer times of the repeated authentication request when the server cannot be connected. To restore to the default value, please use no dot1x max-req command. Syntax dot1x max-req times no dot1x max-req Parameter times —— The maximum transfer times of the repeated authentication request, ranging from 1 to 9 in times. By default, the value is 3. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the maximum transfer times of the repeated authentication request as 5 on the Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x max-req 5 37.11 dot1x Description The dot1x command is used to enable the IEEE 802.1x function for a specified port. To disable the IEEE 802.1x function for a specified port, please use no dot1x command. 328 Syntax dot1x no dot1x Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet ) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the IEEE 802.1x function for the Gigabit Ethernet port 1: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x 37.12 dot1x port-control Description The dot1x port-control command is used to configure the Control Mode of IEEE 802.1x for the specified port. By default, the control mode is “auto”. To restore to the default configuration, please use no dot1x port-control command. Syntax dot1x port-control {auto | authorized-force | unauthorized-force} no dot1x port-control Parameter auto | authorized-force | unauthorized-force —— The Control Mode for the port. auto: In this mode, the port will normally work only after passing the 802.1x Authentication. authorized-force: In this mode, the port can work normally without passing the 802.1x Authentication. unauthorized-force: In this mode, the port is forbidden working for its fixed unauthorized status. 329 Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the Control Mode “authorized-force”: for Gigabit Ethernet port 20 as T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/20 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x port-control authorized-force 37.13 dot1x port-method Description The dot1x port-method command is used to configure the control type of IEEE 802.1x for the specified port. By default, the control type is “mac-based”. To restore to the default configuration, please use no dot1x port-method command. Syntax dot1x port-method { mac-based | port-based } no dot1x port-method Parameter mac-based | port-based ——The control type for the port. mac-based: Any client connected to the port should pass the 802.1x authentication for access. port-based: All the clients connected to the port can access the network on the condition that any one of the clients has passed the 802.1x Authentication. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) 330 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the Control Type for Gigabit Ethernet port 20 as “port-based”: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/20 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x port-method port-based 37.14 dot1x auth-init Description The dot1x auth-init command is used to initialize the specific client. Syntax dot1x auth-init [ mac mac-address ] Parameter mac-address: Enter the MAC address of the client that will be unauthorized. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement None. Example Initialize the client whose MAC address is a 00:02:58:4f:6c:23 on port 1: T1600G-28TS(Config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(Config-if)#dot1x auth-init mac 00:02:58:4f:6c:23 37.15 dot1x auth-reauth Description The dot1x auth-reauth command is used to reauthenticate the specific client. 331 Syntax dot1x auth-reauth [ mac mac-address ] Parameter mac-address: Enter the MAC address of the client that will be reauthenticated. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement None. Example Reauthenticate the client whose MAC address is a 00:02:58:4f:6c:23 on port 1: T1600G-28TS(Config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(Config-if)#dot1x auth-reauth mac 00:02:58:4f:6c:23 37.16 show dot1x global Description The show dot1x global command is used to display the global configuration of 801.X. Syntax show dot1x global Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configuration of 801.X globally: T1600G-28TS(config)#show dot1x global 332 37.17 show dot1x interface Description The show dot1x interface command is used to display all ports or the specified port’s configuration information of 801.X. Syntax show dot1x interface [ gigabitEthernet port ] Parameter port —— The Ethernet port number. If not specified, the information of all the ports will be displayed. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configuration information of 801.X for Gigabit Ethernet port 20: T1600G-28TS(config)#show dot1x interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/20 Display the configuration information of 801.X for all Ethernet ports: T1600G-28TS(config)#show dot1x interface 37.18 show dot1x auth-state Description The show dot1x auth-state command is used to display the authentication status of each port. Syntax show dot1x auth-state Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. 333 Example Display the authentication status of each port: T1600G-28TS(config)#show dot1x auth-state 334 Chapter 38 Port Security Commands You can limit the number of MAC addresses that can be learned on each port on this page, thus preventing the MAC address table from being exhausted by the attack packets. 38.1 mac address-table max-mac count Description The mac address-table max-mac-count command is used to enable the port security feature of the port and configure the related parameters. To disable the feature and restore the parameters to defaults on the port, please use no Syntax mac address-table max-mac-count command. mac address-table max-mac-count { [ max-number num ] [ exceed-max-learned enable | disable ] [ mode { dynamic | static | permanent } ] [ status { forward | drop | disable } ] } no mac address-table max-mac-count [ max-number | mode | status ] Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Set the maximum number of MAC addresses that can be learned on port 1/0/1 as 30, enable exceed-max-leaned feature and configure the mode as permanent and the status as drop: T1600G-28TS (config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#mac address-table max-mac-count max-number 30 exceed-maxlearned enable mode permanent status drop 38.2 show mac address-table max-mac-count Description The show mac address-table max-mac-count command is used to display the port security configuration on each port. 335 Syntax show mac address-table max-mac-count interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port } Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the port security configuration on port 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS# show mac address-table max-mac-count interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 336 Chapter 39 Port Mirroring Commands Port Mirroring allows the switch to send a copy of the traffic that passes through specified sources (ports, LAGs or the CPU) to a destination port. It does not affect the switching of network traffic on source ports, LAGs or the CPU. Usually, the monitoring port is connected to data diagnose device, which is used to analyze the monitored packets for monitoring and troubleshooting the network. 39.1 monitor session destination interface Description The monitor session destination interface command is used to configure the monitoring port. Each monitor session has only one monitoring port. To change the monitoring port, please use the monitor session destination interface command by changing the port value. The no monitor session command is used to delete the corresponding monitoring port or monitor Syntax session. monitor session session_num destination interface gigabitEthernet port no monitor session session_num destination interface gigabitEthernet port no monitor session session_num Parameter session_num —— The monitor session number, can only be specified as 1. port —— The monitoring port number. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Create monitor session 1 and configure port 1/0/1 as the monitoring port: T1600G-28TS(config)# monitor session 1 destination gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 Delete the monitoring port 1/0/2 from monitor session 1: 337 interface T1600G-28TS(config)# no monitor session 1 destination interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 Delete the monitor session 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# no monitor session 1 39.2 monitor session source Description The monitor session source command is used to configure the monitored interface. To delete the corresponding monitored interface, please use no Syntax monitor session source command. monitor session session_num source { cpu cpu_number | interface gigabitEthernet port-list | interface port-channel port-channel-id } mode no monitor session session_num source { cpu cpu_number | interface gigabitEthernet port-list | interface port-channel port-channel-id } mode Parameter session_num —— The monitor session number. It can only be specified as 1. cpu_number —— The CPU number. It can only be specified as 1. port-list —— List of the Ethernet port number. It is multi-optional. lag-list —— List of LAG interfaces. It is multi-optional. mode —— The monitor mode. There are three options: rx, tx and both. Rx (ingress monitoring mode), means the incoming packets received by the monitored interface will be copied to the monitoring port. Tx (egress monitoring mode), indicates the outgoing packets sent by the monitored interface will be copied to the monitoring port. Both (ingress and egress monitoring), presents the incoming packets received and the outgoing packets sent by the monitored interface will both be copied to the monitoring port. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. 338 User Guidelines 1. The monitoring port is corresponding to current interface configuration mode. 2. Monitored ports number is not limited, but it can’t be the monitoring port at the same time. 3. Whether the monitoring port and monitored ports are in the same VLAN or not is not demanded strictly. 4. Example The monitoring port and monitored ports cannot be link-aggregation member. Create monitor session 1, then configure port 4, 5, 7 as monitored port and enable ingress monitoring: T1600G-28TS(config)# monitor session 1 source interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/4-5,1/0/7 rx Delete port 4 in monitor session 1 and its configuration: T1600G-28TS(config)# no monitor session 1 source interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/4 rx 39.3 show monitor session Description The show monitor session command is used to display the configuration of Syntax port monitoring. show monitor session [session_num] Parameter session_num —— The monitor session number, can only be specified as 1. It is optional. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the monitoring configuration of monitor session 1: 339 T1600G-28TS(config)# show monitor session 1 340 Chapter 40 ACL Commands ACL (Access Control List) is used to filter data packets by configuring a series of match conditions, operations and time ranges. It provides a flexible and secured access control policy and facilitates you to control the network security. 40.1 access-list create Description Syntax The access-list create command is used to create an ACL. access-list create acl-id [ name acl-name ] no access-list create { acl-id } Parameter acl-id ——Enter an ACL ID. The IDs for MAC ACL are from 0 to 499. The IDs for IP ACL are from 500 to 999. The IDs for IPv6 ACL are from 1500 to 1999. acl-name —— Enter a name to identify the ACL. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create an IP ACL whose ID is 523: T1600G-28TS(config)# access-list create 523 40.2 access-list resequence Description Syntax The access-list resequence command is used to resequence the rules by providing a Start Rule ID and Step value. access-list resequence acl-id-or-name start start-rule-id step rule-id-step-value 341 Parameter acl-id-or-name —— The ACL ID or name. start-rule-id —— The start rule ID. rule-id-step-value —— The step value. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Resequence the rules of ACL 12 with the start ID as 1 and step value as 5: T1600G-28TS(config)# access-list resequence 12 start 1 step 5 40.3 access-list mac Description The access-list mac command is used to create MAC ACL. To delete the Syntax MAC ACL, please use no access-list mac. access-list mac acl-id-or-name rule { auto | rule-id } { deny | permit } logging {enable | disable} [smac source-mac smask source-mac-mask ] [dmac destination-mac dmask destination-mac-mask ] [type ether-type] [pri dot1p-priority] [vid vlan-id] [tseg time-range-name] no access-list mac acl-id-or-name rule rule-id Parameter acl-id-or-name —— Enter the ID or name of the ACL that you want to add a rule for. auto —— The rule ID will be assigned automatically and the interval between rule IDs is 5. rule-id —— Assign an ID to the rule. deny | permit —— Specify the action to be taken with the packets that match the rule. By default, it is set to permit. The packets will be discarded if “deny” is selected and forwarded if “permit” is selected. enable | disable —— Enable or disable Logging function for the ACL rule. If "enable " is selected, the times that the rule is matched will be logged every 5 342 minutes. With ACL Counter trap enabled, a related trap will be generated if the matching times changes. source-mac —— Enter the source MAC address. The format is FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF. source-mac-mask —— Enter the mask of the source MAC address. This is required if a source MAC address is entered. The format is FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF. destination-mac —— Enter the destination MAC address. The format is FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF. destination-mac-mask —— Enter the mask of the destination MAC address. This is required if a destination MAC address is entered. The format is FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF. ether-type —— Specify an Ethernet-type with 4 hexadecimal numbers. dot1p-priority: The user priority ranges from 0 to 7. The default is No Limit. vlan-id —— The VLAN ID ranges from 1 to 4094. time-range-name —— The name of the time-range. The default is No Limit. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create MAC ACL 50 and configure Rule 5 to permit packets with source MAC address 00:34:a2:d4:34:b5: T1600G-28TS (config)#access-list create 50 T1600G-28TS (config-mac-acl)#access-list mac 50 rule 5 permit logging disable smac 00:34:a2:d4:34:b5 smask ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff 40.4 access-list ip Description The access-list ip command is used to add IP ACL rule. To delete the corresponding rule, please use no access-list ip command. IP ACLs analyze and process data packets based on a series of match conditions, which can be the source IP addresses and destination IP addresses carried in the packets. 343 Syntax access-list ip acl-id-or-name rule {auto | rule-id } {deny | permit} logging {enable | disable} [ sip sip-address sip-mask sip-address-mask ] [ dip dip-address dip-mask dip-address-mask ] [dscp dscp-value] [tos tos-value] [pre pre-value] [protocol protocol [s-port s-port-number] [s-port-mask s-port-mask] [d-port d-port-number] [d-port-mask d-port-mask] [tcpflag tcpflag]] [tseg time-range-name] no access-list ip acl-id-or-name rule rule-id Parameter acl-id-or-name —— Enter the ID or name of the ACL that you want to add a rule for. auto —— The rule ID will be assigned automatically and the interval between rule IDs is 5. rule-id —— Assign an ID to the rule. deny | permit —— Specify the action to be taken with the packets that match the rule. By default, it is set to permit. The packets will be discarded if “deny” is selected and forwarded if “permit” is selected. logging {enable | disable} —— Enable or disable Logging function for the ACL rule. If "enable " is selected, the times that the rule is matched will be logged every 5 minutes. With ACL Counter trap enabled, a related trap will be generated if the matching times changes. sip-address —— Enter the source IP address. sip-address-mask —— Enter the mask of the source IP address. This is required if a source IP address is entered. dip-address —— Enter the destination IP address. dip-address-mask —— Enter the mask of the destination IP address. This is required if a destination IP address is entered. dscp-value —— Specify the DSCP value between 0 and 63. tos-value ——Specify an IP ToS value to be matched between 0 and 15. pre-value ——Specify an IP Precedence value to be matched between 0 and 7. protocol —— Specify a protocol type. s-port-number —— Specify the source port number. s-port-mask —— Specify the source port mask with 4 hexadecimal numbers. d-port-number —— Specify the destination port number. 344 d-port-mask —— Specify the destination port mask with 4 hexadacimal numbers. tcpflag —— For TCP protocol, specify the flag value using either binary numbers or * (for example, 01*010*). The default is *, which indicates that the flag will not be matched. The flags are URG (Urgent flag), ACK (acknowledge flag), PSH(push flag), RST(reset flag),SYN(synchronize flag), and FIN(finish flag). time-range-name —— The name of the time-range. The default is No Limit. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create IP ACL 600, and configure Rule 1 to permit packets with source IP address 192.168.1.100: T1600G-28TS (config)#access-list create 600 T1600G-28TS (config)#access-list ip 600 rule 1 permit logging disable sip 192.168.1.100 sip-mask 255.255.255.255 40.5 access-list ipv6 Description The access-list ipv6 command is used to add IPv6 ACL rule. To delete the corresponding rule, please use no access-list ipv6 command. IPv6 ACLs analyze and process data packets based on a series of match conditions, which can be the source IP addresses and destination IP addresses carried in Syntax the packets, the DSCP and flow-label value, etc. access-list ipv6 acl-id-or-name rule {auto | rule-id } {deny | permit} logging {enable | disable} [class class-value] [flow-label flow-label-value] [sip source-ip-address sip-mask source-ip-mask] [dip destination-ip-address dip-mask destination-ip-mask] [s-port source-port-number] destination-port-number] [tseg time-range-name] no access-list ipv6 acl-id-or-name rule rule-id 345 [d-port Parameter acl-id-or-name —— Enter the ID or name of the ACL that you want to add a rule for. auto —— The rule ID will be assigned automatically and the interval between rule IDs is 5. rule-id —— Assign an ID to the rule. deny | permit —— Specify the action to be taken with the packets that match the rule. By default, it is set to permit. The packets will be discarded if “deny” is selected and forwarded if “permit” is selected. logging {enable | disable} —— Enable or disable Logging function for the ACL rule. If "enable " is selected, the times that the rule is matched will be logged every 5 minutes. With ACL Counter trap enabled, a related trap will be generated if the matching times changes. class-value —— Specify a class value to be matched. It ranges from 0 to 63. flow-label-value —— Specify a Flow Label value to be matched. source-ip-address —— Enter the source IP address. Enter the destination IPv6 address to be matched. All types of IPv6 address will be checked. You may enter a complete 128-bit IPv6 address but only the first 64 bits will be valid. source-ip-mask —— Enter the source IP address mask. The mask is required if the source IPv6 address is entered. Enter the mask in complete format (for example, ffff:ffff:0000:ffff). The mask specifies which bits in the source IPv6 address to match the rule. destination-ip-address —— Enter the destination IPv6 address to be matched. All types of IPv6 address will be checked. You may enter a complete 128-bit IPv6 addresses but only the first 64 bits will be valid. destination-ip-mask: Enter the source IP address mask. The mask is required if the source IPv6 address is entered. Enter the mask in complete format (for example, ffff:ffff:0000:ffff). The mask specifies which bits in the source IPv6 address to match the rule. source-port-number —— Enter the TCP/UDP source port if TCP/UDP protocol is selected. destination-port-number —— Enter the TCP/UDP destination port if TCP/UDP protocol is selected. time-range-name —— The name of the time-range. The default is No Limit. 346 Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. User Guidelines Before binding an IPv6 ACL to a VLAN or interface, you should configure the SDM template as “enterpriseV6” and save your configurations. Example Create IPv6 ACL 1600 and configure Rule 1 to deny packets with source IPv6 address CDCD:910A:2222:5498:8475:1111:3900:2020: T1600G-28TS(config)# access-list create 1600 T1600G-28TS(config)# access-list ipv6 1600 rule 1 deny logging disable sip CDCD:910A:2222:5498:8475:1111:3900:2020 sip-mask ffff:ffff:ffff:ffff 40.6 access-list action Description The access-list action command is used to specify a rule to be configured with policies and enter Action Configuration mode. To delete the Syntax corresponding policies, please use no access-list action command. access-list action acl-id-or-name rule rule-id no access-list action acl-id-or-name rule rule-id Parameter acl-id-or-name —— Enter the ID or name of the ACL. rule-id —— Enter the ID of the ACL rule. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the rule 1 of ACL 200 to be configured with policies: 347 T1600G-28TS(config)# access-list action 200 rule 1 40.7 redirect interface Description The redirect interface command is used to define the policy to redirect the matched packets to the desired port. To disable this policy, please use no Syntax redirect interface command. redirect interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port } no redirect interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port } Parameter port —— The destination port to which the packets will be redirected. The default is All. Command Mode Action Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Define the policy to redirect the matched packets to port 1/0/1 for rule 1 of ACL 6: T1600G-28TS(config)# access-list action 6 rule 1 T1600G-28TS(config-action)# redirect interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 40.8 s-condition Description The s-condition command is used to limit the rate of the matched packets. Syntax To restore the settings to the defaults, please use no s-condition. s-condition rate rate burst burst-size osd { none | discard } no s-condition 348 Parameter rate —— Specify a rate, ranging from 0 to 1000000kbps. burst-size —— Specify the number of bytes allowed in one second ranging from 1 to 128. osd ——Select either “none” or “discard” as the action to be taken for the packets whose rate is beyond the specified rate. The default is None. Command Mode Action Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure a policy for rule 1 of ACL 6: limit the transmission rate of the matched packets as 1000 Kbps and if the number of bytes per second is beyond 100, the packets will be discarded by the switch: T1600G-28TS(config)#access-list action 6 rule 1 T1600G-28TS(config-action)# s-condition rate 1000 burst 100 osd discard 40.9 s-mirror Description The s-mirror command is used to define the policy to mirror the matched packets to the desired port. To disable this policy, please use no s-mirror Syntax command. s-mirror interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port } Parameter port —— The destination port to which the packets will be mirrored. Command Mode Action Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 349 Example Configure a policy for rule 1 of ACL 6: specify the mirror port as Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/2 for the data packets matching this rule: T1600G-28TS(config)#access-list action 6 rule 1 T1600G-28TS(config-action)#s-mirror interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 40.10 qos-remark Description The qos-remark command is used to configure QoS Remark function of policy action. To restore the settings to the default, please use no Syntax qos-remark. qos-remark [ dscp dscp ] [ priority pri ] [dot1p dot1p-pri] no qos-remark Parameter dscp —— DSCP of QoS Remark. Specify the DSCP region for the data packets matching the corresponding ACL. DSCP ranges from 0 to 63. By default, it is not limited. pri —— Local Priority of QoS Remark. Specify the local priority for the data packets matching the corresponding ACL. Local Priority ranges from 0 to 7. dot1p-pri —— 802.1P priority of QoS Remark. This remark configuration will change the data packet's 802.1P priority field to the dot1p-pri you set. 802.1P priority ranges from 0 to 7. Note: The DSCP and dot1p cannot be configured at the same time. Command Mode Action Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure a policy for rule 1 of ACL 6: specify the DSCP region as 30 and local priority 2 for the packets matching this rule: 350 T1600G-28TS(config)#access-list action 6 rule 1 T1600G-28TS(config-action)# qos-remark dscp 30 priority 2 40.11 access bind Description The access-list policy name command is used to add Policy. To delete the corresponding Policy, please use no access-list policy name command. A Policy is used to control the data packets those match the corresponding Syntax ACL rules. access-list bind acl-id-or-name interface { [ vlan vlan-list ] | [ fastEthernet port-list ] | [gigabitEthernet port-list ] | [ ten-gigabitEthernet port-list ] } no access-list bind acl-id-or-name interface { [ vlan vlan-list ] | [ fastEthernet port-list ] | [gigabitEthernet port-list ] | [ ten-gigabitEthernet port-list ] } Parameter acl-id-or-name —— Enter the ID or name of the ACL that you want to add a rule for. vlan-list —— Specify the ID or the ID list of the VLAN(s) that you want to bind the ACL to. The valid values are from 1 to 4094, for example, 2-3,5. port-list —— Specify the number or the list of the Ethernet port that you want to bind the ACL to. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Bind ACL 1 to port 3 and VLAN 4: T1600G-28TS(config)#access-list bind 1 interface vlan 4 gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 351 40.12 show access-list Description Syntax The show access-list command is used to display configuration of ACL. show access-list acl-id-or-name Parameter acl-id-or-name —— The ID or name of the ACL selected to display the configuration. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configuration of the MAC ACL whose ID is 20: T1600G-28TS(config)# show access-list 20 40.13 show access-list bind Description The show access-list bind command is used to display the configuration of Syntax ACL binding. show access-list bind Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configuration of Policy bind: T1600G-28TS(config)# show access-list bind 352 40.14 show access-list status Description The show access-list status command is used to display usage status of Syntax ACL entry resource. show access-list status Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the usage status of ACL entry resource: T1600G-28TS(config)# show access-list status 40.15 show access-list counter Description The show access-list counter command is used to display the packet Syntax counter of a specified ACL. show access-list acl-id-or-name counter Parameter acl-id-or-name —— The ID or name of the ACL to display. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the packet counter of ACL 100: T1600G-28TS(config)# show access-list 100 counter 353 40.16 clear access-list Description The show access-list command is used to clear the counter of matched Syntax packets of a specified ACL or rule. clear access-list acl-id-or-name [rule rule-id] Parameter acl-id-or-name —— The ID or name of the ACL. rule-id—— The ID of the rule. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Clear the packet counter of ACL 100: T1600G-28TS(config)# clear access-list 100 354 Chapter 41 IPv4 IMPB Commands You can bind the IP address, MAC address, VLAN and the connected Port number of the Host together, which can be the condition for the ARP Inspection and IP verify source to filter the packets. 41.1 ip source binding Description The ip source binding command is used to bind the IP address, MAC address, VLAN ID and the Port number together manually. You can manually bind the IP address, MAC address, VLAN ID and the Port number together in the condition that you have got the related information of the Hosts in the LAN. To delete the IP-MAC–VID-PORT entry from the binding table, please use no ip source binding index command. Syntax ip source binding hostname ip-addr mac-addr vlan vlan-id interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id } { none | arp-detection | ip-verify-source | both } no ip source binding index ip-addr Parameter hostname ——The Host Name, which contains 20 characters at most. ip-addr —— The IP address of the Host. mac-addr —— The MAC address of the Host. vlan-id ——The VLAN ID needed to be bound, ranging from 1 to 4094. port —— The number of port connected to the Host. none | arp-detection | ip-verify-source | both ——The protect type for the entry. “arp-detection” indicates ARP detection; “ip-verify-source” indicates IP source filter; “none” indicates applying none; “both” indicates applying both. ip-addr —— The IP address of the entry to be deleted. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode 355 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Bind an ACL entry with the IP 192.168.0.1, MAC 00:00:00:00:00:01, VLAN ID 2 and the Port number 5 manually. And then enable the entry for the ARP detection: T1600G-28TS(config)#ip source binding host1 192.168.0.1 00:00:00:00:00:01 vlan 2 interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 arp-detection Delete the IP-MAC–VID-PORT entry with the index 5: T1600G-28TS(config)#no ip source binding index 5 41.2 ip dhcp snooping Description The ip dhcp snooping command is used to enable DHCP Snooping function globally. To disable DHCP Snooping function globally, please use no ip dhcp snooping command. DHCP Snooping functions to monitor the process of the Host obtaining the IP address from DHCP server, and record the IP address, MAC address, VLAN and the connected Port number of the Host for automatic binding. Syntax ip dhcp snooping no ip dhcp snooping Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the DHCP Snooping function globally: T1600G-28TS(config)#ip dhcp snooping 356 41.3 ip dhcp snooping vlan Description The ip dhcp snooping vlan command is used to enable DHCP Snooping function on a specified VLAN. To disable DHCP Snooping function on this VLAN, please use no ip dhcp snooping vlan command. Syntax ip dhcp snooping vlan vlan-range no ip dhcp snooping vlan vlan-range Parameter vlan-range —— Specify the VLANs to enable the DHCP snooping function, in the format of 1-3, 5. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the DHCP Snooping function on VLAN 1,4,6-7: T1600G-28TS(config)#ip dhcp snooping vlan 1,4,6-7 41.4 ip dhcp snooping max-entries Description The ip dhcp snooping max-entries command is used to configure the maximum number of entries that can be learned on a port via DHCP Snooping. To restore to the default setting, please use no ip dhcp snooping max-entries command. Syntax ip dhcp snooping max-entries value no ip dhcp snooping max-entries 357 Syntax value —— Enter the value of maximum number of entries that can be learned on the port via DHCP Snooping. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the maximum number of entries that can be learned on port 1 as 100: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip dhcp snooping max-entries 100 41.5 show ip source binding Description The show ip source binding command is used to display the IP-MAC-VID- PORT binding table. Syntax show ip source binding Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the IP-MAC-VID-PORT binding table: T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip source binding 358 41.6 show ip dhcp snooping Description The show ip dhcp snooping command is used to display the running status of DHCP Snooping. Syntax show ip dhcp snooping Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the running status of DHCP Snooping: T1600G-28TS#show ip dhcp snooping 41.7 show ip dhcp snooping interface Description The show ip dhcp snooping interface command is used to display the DHCP Snooping configuration of a desired Gigabit Ethernet port/port channel or of all Ethernet ports/port channels. Syntax show ip dhcp snooping interface [ gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] Parameters port —— The Ethernet port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. 359 Example Display the DHCP Snooping configuration of all Ethernet ports and port channels: T1600G-28TS#show ip dhcp snooping interface Display the DHCP Snooping configuration of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/5: T1600G-28TS#show ip dhcp snooping interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 360 Chapter 42 IPv6 IMPB Commands You can bind the IPv6 address, MAC address, VLAN and the connected Port number of the Host together, which can be the condition for the ARP Inspection and IP verify source to filter the packets. 42.1 Ipv6 source binding Description The ipv6 source binding command is used to bind the IPv6 address, MAC address, VLAN ID and the Port number together manually. You can manually bind the IPv6 address, MAC address, VLAN ID and the Port number together in the condition that you have got the related information of the Hosts in the LAN. To delete the IPv6-MAC–VID-PORT entry from the binding table, please use no ipv6 source binding index command. Syntax Ipv6 source binding hostname ipv6-addr mac-addr vlan vlan-id interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id } { none | nd-detection | ipv6-verify-source | both } no ipv6 source binding index ipv6-addr Parameter hostname ——The Host Name, which contains 20 characters at most. Ipv6-addr —— The IP address of the Host. mac-addr —— The MAC address of the Host. vlan-id ——The VLAN ID needed to be bound, ranging from 1 to 4094. port —— The number of port connected to the Host. none | nd-detection | ipv6-verify-source | both ——The protect type for the entry. “nd-detection” indicates ND detection; “ipv6-verify-source” indicates IPv6 source filter; “none” indicates applying none; “both” indicates applying both. Ipv6-addr —— The IPv6 address of the entry to be deleted. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode 361 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example The following example shows how to bind an entry with the hostname host1, IPv6 address 2001:0:9d38:90d5::34, MAC address AA-BB-CC-DD-EE-FF, VLAN ID 10, port number 1/0/5, and enable this entry for ND Detection. T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 source binding host1 2001:0:9d38:90d5::34 aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff vlan 10 interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 nd-detection 42.2 ipv6 dhcp snooping Description The ipv6 dhcp snooping command is used to enable DHCPv6 Snooping function globally. To disable DHCPv6 Snooping function globally, please use no ipv6 dhcp snooping command. DHCPv6 Snooping functions to monitor the process of the Host obtaining the IP address from DHCPv6 server, and record the IPv6 address, MAC address, VLAN and the connected Port number of the Host for automatic binding. Syntax Ipv6 dhcp snooping no ipv6 dhcp snooping Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the DHCPv6 Snooping function globally: T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 dhcp snooping 362 42.3 ipv6 dhcp snooping vlan Description The ipv6 dhcp snooping vlan command is used to enable DHCP Snooping function on a specified VLAN. To disable DHCP Snooping function on this VLAN, please use no ipv6 dhcp snooping vlan command. Syntax ipv6 dhcp snooping vlan vlan-range no ipv6 dhcp snooping vlan vlan-range Parameter vlan-range —— Specify the VLANs to enable the DHCP snooping function, in the format of 1-3, 5. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the DHCPv6 Snooping function on VLAN 1,4,6-7: T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 dhcp snooping vlan 1,4,6-7 42.4 ipv6 dhcp snooping max-entries Description The ipv6 dhcp snooping max-entries command is used to configure the maximum number of entries that can be learned on a port via DHCPv6 Snooping. To restore to the default setting, please use no ipv6 dhcp snooping max-entries command. Syntax Ipv6 dhcp snooping max-entries value no ipv6 dhcp snooping max-entries 363 Syntax value: Enter the value of maximum number of entries that can be learned on the port via DHCPv6 Snooping. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the maximum number of entries that can be learned on port 1 as 100: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ipv6 dhcp snooping max-entries 100 42.5 ipv6 nd snooping Description The ipv6 nd snooping command is used to enable ND snooping function globally. To disable ND Snooping function globally, please use no ipv6 nd snooping command. ND Snooping functions to monitor the process of the duplication address detection, and record the IPv6 address, MAC address, VLAN and the connected Port number of the Host for automatic binding. Syntax ipv6 nd snooping no ipv6 nd snooping Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example 364 Enable the ND snooping function globally: T160G-28TS(config)#ipv6 nd snooping 42.6 ipv6 nd snooping vlan Description The ipv6 nd snooping vlan command is used to enable ND snooping function on a specified VLAN. To disable ND Snooping function on this VLAN, please use no ipv6 nd snooping vlan command. Syntax ipv6 nd snooping vlan vlan-range no ipv6 nd snooping vlan vlan-range Parameter vlan-range —— Specify the VLANs to enable the ND snooping function, in the format of 1-3, 5. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the ND snooping function on VLAN 1,4,6-7: T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 nd snooping vlan 1,4,6-7 42.7 ipv6 nd snooping max-entries Description The ipv6 nd snooping max-entries command is used to specify the maximum number of binding entries that are allow to be bound to a port. To return the default, please use no ipv6 nd snooping max-entries command. Syntax ipv6 nd snooping max-entries value 365 no ipv6 nd snooping max-entries Parameter value —— Specify the maximum number of ND snooping entries on this interface. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the maximum number of binding entries from ND Snooping of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/2 is 100: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ipv6 nd snooping max-entries 100 42.8 show ipv6 source binding Description The show ipv6 source binding command is used to display the IPv6-MAC-VID- PORT binding table. Syntax show ipv6 source binding Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the IPv6-MAC-VID-PORT binding table: T1600G-28TS(config)#show ipv6 source binding 366 42.9 show ipv6 dhcp snooping Description The show ipv6 dhcp snooping command is used to display the running status of DHCPv6 Snooping. Syntax show ipv6 dhcp snooping Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the running status of DHCPv6 Snooping: T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 dhcp snooping 42.10 show ipv6 dhcp snooping interface Description The show ipv6 dhcp snooping interface command is used to display the DHCPv6 Snooping configuration of a desired Gigabit Ethernet port/port channel or of all Ethernet ports/port channels. Syntax show ipv6 dhcp snooping interface [ gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] Parameters port —— The Ethernet port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. 367 Example Display the DHCPv6 Snooping configuration of all Ethernet ports and port channels: T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 dhcp snooping interface Display the DHCPv6 Snooping configuration of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/5: T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 dhcp snooping interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 42.11 show ipv6 nd snooping Description The show ipv6 nd snooping command is used to display the running status of ND Snooping. Syntax show ipv6 nd snooping Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the running status of ND Snooping: T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 nd snooping 368 Chapter 43 IP Verify Source Commands IP Verify Source is to filter the IP packets based on the IP-MAC Binding entries. Only the packets matched to the IP-MAC Binding rules can be processed, which can enhance the bandwidth utility. 43.1 ip verify source Description The ip verify source command is used to configure the IP Verify Source mode for a specified port. To disable the IP Verify Source function, please use no ip verify source command. Syntax ip verify source { sip+mac | sip } no ip verify source Parameter sip+mac —— Security type. “sip+mac” indicates that only the packets with its source IP address, source MAC address and port number matched to the IP-MAC binding rules can be processed. sip —— Security type. “sip” indicates that only the packets with its source IP address and port number matched to the IP-MAC binding rules can be processed. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the IP Verify Source function for Gigabit Ethernet ports 5-10. Configure that only the packets with its source IP address, source MAC address and port number matched to the IP-MAC binding rules can be processed: 369 T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/5-10 T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ip verify source sip+mac 43.2 ip verify source logging Description The ip verify source logging command is used to enable the log feature. With this feature enabled, the switch will generate a log when illegal packets are received. To disable the log feature, please use no ip verify source logging command. Syntax ip verify source logging no ip verify source logging Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the log feature to make the switch generate logs when receiving illegal packets: T1600G-28TS(config)#ip verify source logging 43.3 show ip verify source Description The show ip verify source command is used to display the IP Verify Source configuration information. Syntax show ip verify source Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 370 Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the IP Verify Source configuration information: T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip verify source 43.4 show ip verify source interface Description The show ip verify source interface command is used to display the IP verify source configuration of a desired Gigabit Ethernet port. Syntax show ip verify source interface [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] Parameters port —— The Ethernet port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the IP verify source configuration of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/5: T1600G-28TS#show ip verify source interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 371 Chapter 44 IPv6 Verify Source Commands IPv6 Verify Source is to filter the IPv6 packets based on the IPv6-MAC Binding entries. Only the packets matched to the IPv6-MAC Binding rules can be processed, which can enhance the bandwidth utility. Before configuring IPv6 Verify Source feature, you should configure the SDM template as “enterpriseV6” and save your configurations. 44.1 ipv6 verify source Description The ipv6 verify source command is used to configure the IPv6 Verify Source mode for a specified port. To disable the IPv6 Verify Source function, please use no ipv6 verify source command. Syntax ipv6 verify source { sipv6+mac | sipv6 } no ipv6 verify source Parameter sipv6+mac —— Security type. “sipv6+mac” indicates that only the packets with its source IPv6 address, source MAC address and port number matched to the IPv6-MAC binding rules can be processed. sipv6 —— Security type. “sipv6” indicates that only the packets with its source IPv6 address and port number matched to the IPv6-MAC binding rules can be processed. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet ) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the IPv6 Verify Source function for Gigabit Ethernet ports 5-10. Configure that only the packets with its source IPv6 address, source MAC 372 address and port number matched to the IPv6-MAC binding rules can be processed: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/5-10 T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ipv6 verify source sipv6+mac 44.2 show ipv6 verify source Description The show ipv6 verify source command is used to display the IPv6 Verify Source configuration information. Syntax show ipv6 verify source Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the IPv6 Verify Source configuration information: T1600G-28TS(config)#show ipv6 verify source 44.3 show ipv6 verify source interface Description The show ipv6 verify source interface command is used to display the IPv6 verify source configuration of a desired Gigabit Ethernet port. Syntax show ipv6 verify source interface gigabitEthernet port Parameters port —— The Ethernet port number. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 373 Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the IPv6 verify source configuration of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/5: T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 verify source interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 374 Chapter 45 DHCPv4 Filter Commands DHCPv4 Filter function allows the user to not only to restrict all DHCP Server packets but also to receive any specified DHCP server packet by any specified DHCP client, it is useful when one or more DHCP servers are present on the network and both provide DHCP services to different distinct groups of clients. 45.1 ip dhcp filter Description The ip dhcp filter command is used to enable DHCP Filter function globally. To disable DHCP Filter function globally, please use no ip dhcp filter command. Syntax ip dhcp filter no ip dhcp filter Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the DHCP Filter function globally: T1600G-28TS(config)#ip dhcp filter 45.2 ip dhcp filter (interface) Description The ip dhcp filter (interface) command is used to enable DHCP Filter function on a specified port. To disable DHCP Filter function on this port, please use no ip dhcp filter (interface) command. 375 Syntax ip dhcp filter no ip dhcp filter Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the DHCP Filter on port 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(Config-if)#ip dhcp filter 45.3 ip dhcp filter mac-verify Description The ip dhcp filter mac-verify command is used to enable the MAC Verify feature. To disable the MAC Verify feature, please use no ip dhcp filter mac-verify command. There are two fields of the DHCP packet containing the MAC address of the Host. The MAC Verify feature is to compare the two fields and discard the packet if the two fields are different. Syntax ip dhcp filter mac-verify no ip dhcp filter mac-verify Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 376 Example Enable the MAC Verify feature for the Gigabit Ethernet port 10/2: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip dhcp filter mac-verify 45.4 ip dhcp filter limit rate Description The ip dhcp filter limit rate command is used to enable the Flow Control feature for the DHCP packets. The excessive DHCP packets will be discarded. To restore to the default configuration, please use no ip dhcp filter limit rate command. Syntax ip dhcp filter limit rate value no ip dhcp filter limit rate Parameter value —— The value of Flow Control. The options are 5/10/15/20/25/30 (packet/second). The default value is 0, which stands for “disable”. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Set the Flow Control of GigabitEthernet port 2 as 20 pps: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip dhcp filter limit rate 20 377 45.5 ip dhcp filter decline rate Description The ip dhcp filter decline rate command is used to enable the Decline Protect feature and configure the rate limit on DHCP Decine packets. The excessive DHCP Decline packets will be discarded. To disable the Decline Protect feature, please use no ip dhcp filter decline rate command. Syntax ip dhcp filter decline rate value no ip dhcp filter decline rate Parameter value —— Specify the rate limit of DHCP Decline packets, and the optional values are 0, 5, 10, 15, 20, 25 and 30 (units:packet/second). It default value is 0, which stands for “disable”. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the rate limit of DHCP Decline packets as 20 packets per second on Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip dhcp filter decline 20 45.6 ip dhcp filter server permit-entry Description The ip dhcp filter server permit-entry command is used to add entry for the legal DHCP server. To restore to the default option, please use no ip dhcp snooping information strategy command. 378 Syntax ip dhcp filter server permit-entry server-ip ipAddr client-mac macAddr interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | interface port-channel port-channel-id } no ip dhcp filter server permit-entry server-ip ipAddr client-mac macAddr interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | interface port-channel port-channel-id } Parameter ipAddr —— Specify the IP address of the legal DHCPv4 server. macAddr —— Specify the MAC address of the DHCP Client. The value “all” means all client mac addresses. port-list | port-channel-id —— Specify the port that the legal DHCPv4 server is connected to. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create an entry for the legal DHCPv4 server whose IP address is 192.168.0.100 and connected port number is 1/0/1 without client MAC address restricted: T1600G-28TS(config)#ip dhcp filter server permit-entry server-ip 192.168.0.100 client-mac all interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 45.7 show ip dhcp filter Description The show ip dhcp filter command is used to display the configuration of DHCP Filter. Syntax show ip dhcp filter 379 Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the DHCP Filter configuration: T1600G-28TS#show ip dhcp filter 45.8 show ip dhcp filter interface Description The show ip dhcp filter interface command is used to display the configuration of DHCP Filter on ports. Syntax show ip dhcp filter interface [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the DHCP Filter configuration on port 1/0/3: T1600G-28TS#show ip dhcp filter interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 45.9 show ip dhcp filter server permit-entry Description The show ip dhcp filter server permit-entry command is used to display the legal server configuration. Syntax show ip dhcp filter server permit-entry 380 Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the legal DHCP server configuration: T1600G-28TS#show ip dhcp filter server permit-entry 381 Chapter 46 DHCPv6 Filter Commands DHCPv6 Filter function allows the user to not only to restrict all DHCPv6 Server packets but also to receive any specified DHCPv6 server packet by any specified DHCPv6 client, it is useful when one or more DHCPv6 servers are present on the network and both provide DHCPv6 services to different distinct groups of clients. 46.1 ipv6 dhcp filter Description The ipv6 dhcp filter command is used to enable DHCP Filter function globally. To disable DHCPv6 Filter function globally, please use no ipv6 dhcp filter command. Syntax Ipv6 dhcp filter no ipv6 dhcp filter Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the DHCPv6 Filter function globally: T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 dhcp filter 46.2 ipv6 dhcp filter (interface) Description The ipv6 dhcp filter (interface) command is used to enable DHCPv6 Filter function on a specified port. To disable DHCPv6v Filter function on this port, please use no ipv6 dhcp filter (interface) command. 382 Syntax ipv6 dhcp filter no ipv6 dhcp filter Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the DHCPv6 Filter on port 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 T1600G-28TS(Config-if)#ipv6 dhcp filter 46.3 ipv6 dhcp filter limit rate Description The ipv6 dhcp filter limit rate command is used to enable the Flow Control feature for the DHCPv6 packets. The excessive DHCPv6 packets will be discarded. To restore to the default configuration, please use no ipv6 dhcp filter limit rate command. Syntax Ipv6 dhcp filter limit rate value no ipv6 dhcp filter limit rate Parameter value —— The value of Flow Control. The options are 5/10/15/20/25/30 (packet/second). The default value is 0, which stands for “disable”. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) 383 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Set the Flow Control of GigabitEthernet port 2 as 20 pps: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ipv6 dhcp filter limit rate 20 46.4 ipv6 dhcp filter decline rate Description The ipv6 dhcp filter decline rate command is used to enable the Decline Protect feature and configure the rate limit on DHCP Decine packets. The excessive DHCPv6 Decline packets will be discarded. To disable the Decline Protect feature, please use no ipv6 dhcp filter decline rate command. Syntax Ipv6 dhcp filter decline rate value no ipv6 dhcp filter decline rate Parameter value —— Specify the rate limit of DHCPv6 Decline packets, and the optional values are 0, 5, 10, 15, 20, 25 and 30 (units:packet/second). It default value is 0, which stands for “disable”. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. 384 Example Configure the rate limit of DHCPv6 Decline packets as 20 packets per second on Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/2: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ipv6 dhcp filter decline 20 46.5 ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry Description The ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry command is used to add entry for the legal DHCPv6 server. To restore to the default option, please use no ipv6 dhcp snooping information strategy command. Syntax Ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry server-ip ipAddr interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | interface port-channel port-channel-id } no ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry server-ip ipAddr interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | interface port-channel port-channel-id } Parameter ipAddr —— Specify the IPv6 address of the legal DHCPv6 server. port-list | port-channel-id —— Specify the port that the legal DHCPv6 server is connected to. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Create an entry for the legal DHCPv6 server whose IP address is 192.168.0.100 and connected port number is 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry server-ip 2003::1 interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 385 46.6 show ipv6 dhcp filter Description The show ipv6 dhcp filter command is used to display the configuration of DHCPv6 Filter. Syntax show ipv6 dhcp filter Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the DHCPv6 Filter configuration: T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 dhcp filter 46.7 show ipv6 dhcp filter interface Description The show ipv6 dhcp filter interface command is used to display the configuration of DHCPv6 Filter on ports. Syntax show ipv6 dhcp filter interface [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the DHCPv6 Filter configuration on port 1/0/3: T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 dhcp filter interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 386 46.8 show ip dhcp filter server permit-entry Description The show ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry command is used to display the legal server configuration. Syntax show ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the legal DHCPv6 server configuration: T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry 387 Chapter 47 DoS Defend Commands DoS (Denial of Service) Attack is to occupy the network bandwidth maliciously by the network attackers or the evil programs sending a lot of service requests to the Host. With the DoS Defend enabled, the switch can analyze the specific field of the received packets and provide the defend measures to ensure the normal working of the local network. 47.1 ip dos-prevent Description The ip dos-prevent command is used to enable the DoS defend function globally. To disable the DoS defend function, please use no ip dos-prevent command. Syntax ip dos-prevent no ip dos-prevent Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the DoS defend function globally: T1600G-28TS(config)#ip dos-prevent 47.2 ip dos-prevent type Description The ip dos-prevent type command is used to select the DoS Defend Type. To disable the corresponding Defend Type, please use no ip dos-prevent type command. 388 Syntax ip dos-prevent type { land | scan-synfin | xma-scan | null-scan | port-less-1024 | blat | ping-flood | syn-flood | win-nuke | ping-of-death | smurf } no ip dos-prevent type { land | scan-synfin | xma-scan | null-scan | port-less-1024 | blat | ping-flood | syn-flood | win-nuke | ping-of-death | smurf } Parameter land ——The attacker sends a specific fake SYN (synchronous) packet to the destination host. Because both of the source IP address and the destination IP address of the SYN packet are set to be the IP address of the host, the host will be trapped in an endless circle of building the initial connection. scan-synfin ——The attacker sends the packet with its SYN field and the FIN field set to 1. The SYN field is used to request initial connection whereas the FIN field is used to request disconnection. Therefore, the packet of this type is illegal. xma-scan ——The attacker sends the illegal packet with its TCP index, FIN, URG and PSH field set to 1. null-scan ——The attacker sends the illegal packet with its TCP index and all the control fields set to 0. During the TCP connection and data transmission, the packets with all control fields set to 0 are considered illegal. port-less-1024 ——The attacker sends the illegal packet with its TCP SYN field set to 1 and source port smaller than 1024. blat ——The attacker sends the illegal packet with the same source port and destination port on Layer 4 and with its URG field set to 1. Similar to the Land Attack, the system performance of the attacked host is reduced because the Host circularly attempts to build a connection with the attacker. ping-flood ——The attacker floods the destination system with Ping packets, creating a broadcast storm that makes it impossible for the system to respond to legal communication. syn-flood ——The attacker uses a fake IP address to send TCP request packets to the server. Upon receiving the request packets, the server responds with SYN-ACK packets. Since the IP address is fake, no response will be returned. The server will keep on sending SYN-ACK packets. If the attacker sends overflowing fake request packets, the network resource will be occupied maliciously and the requests of the legal clients will be denied. win-nuke ——Because the Operation System with bugs cannot correctly process the URG (Urgent Pointer) of TCP packets, the attacker sends this 389 type of packets to the TCP port139 (NetBIOS) of the host with the Operation System bugs, which will cause the host with a blue screen. ping-of-death ——Ping of Death attack means that the attacker sends abnormal ping packets larger than 65535 bytes to cause system crash on the target computer. smurf ——Smurf attack is a distributed denial-of-service attack in which large numbers of Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets with the intended victim’s spoofed source IP are broadcast to a computer network using an IP broadcast address. Most devices on a network will, by default, respond to this by sending a reply to the source IP address. If the number of machines on the network that receive and respond to these packets is very large, the victim’s computer will be flooded with traffic. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the DoS Defend Type named Land attack: T1600G-28TS(config)#ip dos-prevent type land 47.3 show ip dos-prevent Description The show ip dos-prevent command is used to display the DoS information of the detected DoS attack, including enable/disable status, the DoS Defend Type, the count of the attack, etc. Syntax show ip dos-prevent Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. 390 Example Display the DoS information of the detected DoS attack globally: T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip dos-prevent 391 Chapter 48 DLDP Commands DLDP (Device Link Detection Protocol) is used to monitor the link state of fiber-optic or twisted-pair Ethernet cables. When a unidirectional link is detected, the corresponding port will be shut down automatically or manually (depending on the shut mode configured). 48.1 dldp (global) Description The dldp command is used to enable the DLDP function globally. To disable it, please use no dldp command. Syntax dldp no dldp Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the DLDP function globally: T1600G-28TS(config)# dldp 48.2 dldp interval Description The dldp interval command is used to define the interval of sending advertisement packets on ports that are in the advertisement state. Syntax dldp interval interval-time Parameter interval-time —— The interval of sending advertisement packets. It ranges from 1 to 30 seconds. By default, it is 5 seconds. 392 Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the interval of sending advertisement packets as 10 seconds: T1600G-28TS(config)# dldp interval 10 48.3 dldp shut-mode Description The dldp shut-mode command is used to configure the shutdown mode when a unidirectional link is detected. Syntax dldp shut-mode { auto | manual } Parameter auto —— The switch automatically shuts down ports when a unidirectional link is detected. By default, the shut-mode is auto. manual ——The switch displays an alert when a unidirectional link is detected. The operation to shut down the unidirectional link ports is accomplished by the users. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the shut-mode as manual: T1600G-28TS(config)# dldp shut-mode manual 393 48.4 dldp(interface) Description The dldp command is used to enable the DLDP function of the specified port. To disable it, please use no dldp command. Syntax dldp no dldp Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the DLDP function of ports 1/0/2-4: T1600G-28TS (config)# interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-4 T1600G-28TS (config-if-range)# dldp 48.5 show dldp Description The show dldp command is used to display the global configuration of DLDP function such as DLDP global state, DLDP interval and shut mode. Syntax show dldp Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the global configuration of DLDP function: 394 T1600G-28TS# show dldp 48.6 show dldp interface Description The show dldp interface command is used to display the configuration and state of the specified Ethernet port. By default, the configuration and state of all the ports will be displayed. Syntax show dldp interface [gigabitEthernet port ] Parameter port —— The Gigabit Ethernet port number. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configuration and state of all ports: T1600G-28TS# show dldp interface Display the configuration and state of port 1/0/5: T1600G-28TS# show dldp interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 395 Chapter 49 SNMP Commands SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) functions are used to manage the network devices for a smooth communication, which can facilitate the network administrators to monitor the network nodes and implement the proper operation. 49.1 snmp-server Description The snmp-server command is used to enable the SNMP function. By default, it is disabled. To return to the default configuration, please use no Syntax snmp-server command. snmp-server no snmp-server Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the SNMP function: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server 49.2 snmp-server view Description The snmp-server view command is used to add View. To delete the corresponding View, please use no snmp-server view command. The OID (Object Identifier) of the SNMP packets is used to describe the managed objects of the switch, and the MIB (Management Information Base) is the set of the OIDs. The SNMP View is created for the SNMP management station to Syntax manage MIB objects. snmp-server view name mib-oid { include | exclude } no snmp-server view name mib-oid 396 Parameter name —— The entry name of View, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. Each View includes several entries with the same name. mib-oid —— MIB Object ID. It is the Object Identifier (OID) for the entry of View, ranging from 1 to 61 characters. include | exclude —— View Type, with include and exclude options. They represent the view entry can/cannot be managed by the SNMP management station individually. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Add a View named view1, configuring the OID as 1.3.6.1.6.3.20, and this OID can be managed by the SNMP management station: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server view view1 1.3.6.1.6.3.20 include 49.3 snmp-server group Description The snmp-server group command is used to manage and configure the SNMP group. To delete the corresponding SNMP group, please use no snmp-server group command. SNMP v3 provides the VACM (View-based Access Control Model) and USM (User-Based Security Model) mechanisms for authentication. The users in the SNMP Group can manage the device via the Read View, Write View and Notify View. And the authentication mode and the privacy mode guarantee the high security for the communication Syntax between the management station and the managed device. snmp-server group name [ smode v3 ] [ slev { noAuthNoPriv | authNoPriv | authPriv }] [ read read-view ] [ write write-view ] [ notify notify-view ] no snmp-server group name smode v3 slev { noAuthNoPriv | authNoPriv | authPriv } Parameter name ——The SNMP Group name, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. The Group Name, Security Model and Security Level compose the identifier of the 397 SNMP Group. These three items of the Users in one group should be the same. v3 —— The security mode for the group, v3 indicates SNMPv3, the most secure level. slev —— The Security Level of SNMP v3 Group. There are three options, including noAuthNoPriv (no authorization and no encryption), authNoPriv (authorization and no encryption) and authPriv (authorization and encryption). By default, the Security Level is noAuthNoPriv. There is no need to configure this in SNMP v1 Mode and SNMP v2c Mode. read-view —— Select the View to be the Read View. The management access is restricted to read-only, and changes cannot be made to the assigned SNMP View. write-view —— Select the View to be the Write View. The management access is writing only and changes can be made to the assigned SNMP View. The View defined both as the Read View and the Write View can be read and modified. notify-view —— Select the View to be the Notify View. The management station can receive notification messages of the assigned SNMP view generated by the switch's SNMP agent. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Add a group, and configure the name as group 1, the Security Model as SNMP v3, the security level as authNoPriv, the management access to the assigned View viewDefault as read-write, besides the notification messages sent by View viewDefault can be received by Management station: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server group group1 smode v3 slev authNoPriv read viewDefault write viewDefault notify viewDefault Delete group 1: T1600G-28TS(config)# no snmp-server group group1 smode v3 slev authNoPriv 398 49.4 snmp-server user Description The snmp-server user command is used to add User. To delete the corresponding User, please use no snmp-server user command. The User in an SNMP Group can manage the switch via the management station software. Syntax The User and its Group have the same security level and access right. snmp-server user name { local | remote } group-name [ smode v3 ] [ slev { noAuthNoPriv | authNoPriv | authPriv }] [ cmode { none | MD5 | SHA }] [ cpwd confirm-pwd ] [ emode { none | DES }] [ epwd encrypt-pwd ] no snmp-server user name Parameter name —— User Name, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. local | remote —— User Type, with local and remote options. Local indicates that the user is connected to a local SNMP engine, while remote means that the user is connected to a remote SNMP engine. As the remote engine ID and user password are used to compute the authentication and privacy digests, before configuring a remote user, you need to set the remote engine ID first. group-name —— The Group Name of the User. The User is classified to the corresponding Group according to its Group Name, Security Model and Security Level. v3 ——The security mode for the user. v3 indicates SNMPv3, the most secure model. slev —— The Security Level of SNMP v3 Group. There are three options, including noAuthNoPriv (no authorization and no encryption), authNoPriv (authorization and no encryption) and authPriv (authorization and encryption). The security level from highest to lowest is: noAuthNoPriv, authNoPriv, authPriv, and the default is noAuthNoPriv. The security level of the user should not be lower than the group it belongs to. cmode —— The Authentication Mode of the SNMP v3 User, with none, MD5 and SHA options. None indicates no authentication method is used, MD5 indicates the port authentication is performed via HMAC-MD5 algorithm and SHA indicates the port authentication is performed via SHA (Secure Hash Algorithm). SHA authentication mode has a higher security than MD5 mode. By default, the Authentication Mode is “none”. 399 confirm-pwd —— Authentication Password, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. The question marks and spaces are not allowed. This password in the configuration file will be displayed in the symmetric encrypted form. emode —— The Privacy Mode of the SNMP v3 User, with none and DES options. None indicates no privacy method is used, and DES indicates DES encryption method is used. By default, the Privacy Mode is “none”. encrypt-pwd —— Privacy Password, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. The question marks and spaces are not allowed. This password in the configuration file will be displayed in the symmetric encrypted form. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Add Local User admin to Group group2, and configure the Security Model of the user as v3, the Security Level of the group as authPriv, the Authentication Mode of the user as MD5, the Authentication Password as 11111, the Privacy Mode as DES, and the Privacy Password as 22222: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server user admin local group2 smode v3 slev authPriv cmode MD5 cpwd 11111 emode DES epwd 22222 49.5 snmp-server community Description The snmp-server community command is used to add Community. To delete the corresponding Community, please use no snmp-server community command. SNMP v1 and SNMP v2c adopt community name authentication. The community name can limit access to the SNMP agent Syntax from SNMP network management station, functioning as a password. snmp-server community name { read-only | read-write } mib-view no snmp-server community name Parameter name —— Community Name, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. read-only | read-write —— The access rights of the community, with read-only and read-write options. 400 mib-view —— The MIB View for the community to access. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Add community public, and the community has read-write management right to View viewDefault: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server community public read-write viewDefault 49.6 snmp-server host Description The snmp-server host command is used to add Notification. To delete the Syntax corresponding Notification, please use no snmp-server host command. snmp-server host ip udp-port user-name [ smode { v1 | v2c | v3 }] [ slev { noAuthNoPriv | authNoPriv | authPriv }] [ type { trap | inform }] [ retries retries ] [ timeout timeout ] no snmp-server host ip user-name Parameter ip —— The IP Address of the management Host. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are supported, for example 192.168.0.100 or fe80::1234. udp-port —— UDP port, which is used to send notifications. The UDP port functions with the IP address for the notification sending. It ranges from 1 to 65535. user-name —— The User name of the management station. smode —— The Security Model of the management station, with v1, v2c and v3 options. By default, the option is v1. slev —— The Security Level of SNMP v3 Group. There are three options, including noAuthNoPriv (no authorization and no encryption), authNoPriv (authorization and no encryption) and authPriv (authorization and encryption). By default, the option is “noAuthNoPriv”. 401 type —— The type of the notifications, with trap and inform options. Trap indicates traps are sent, while inform indicates informs are sent. The inform type has a higher security than the trap type and resend and timeout need to be configured if you select this option. You can only select the trap type in Security Model v1. By default, the type of the notifications is “trap”. retries —— The amount of times the switch retries an inform request, ranging from 1 to 255. The switch will resend the inform request if it doesn’t get the response from the management station during the Timeout interval, and it will terminate resending the inform request if the resending times reach the specified Retry times. timeout —— The maximum time for the switch to wait for the response from the management station before resending a request, ranging from 1 to 3600 in seconds. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Add a Notification entry, and configure the IP address of the management Host as 192.168.0.146, the UDP port as 162, the User name of the management station as admin, the Security Model of the management station as v2c, the type of the notifications as inform, the maximum time for the switch to wait as 1000 seconds, and the retries time as 100: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server host 192.168.0.146 162 admin smode v2c type inform retries 100 timeout 1000 Add a Notification entry, and configure the IP Address of the management Host as fe80::1234, the UDP port as 162, the User name of the management station as admin, the Security Model of the management station as v2c, the type of the notifications as inform, the maximum time for the switch to wait as 1000 seconds, and the retries time as 100: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server host fe80::1234 162 admin smode v2c type inform retries 100 timeout 1000 402 49.7 snmp-server engineID Description The snmp-server engineID command is used to configure the local and remote engineID of the switch. To restore to the default setting, please use Syntax no snmp-server engineID command. snmp-server engineID { [ local local-engineID ] [ remote remote-engineID ] } no snmp-server engineID Parameter local-engineID —— Local Engine ID for local clients. The Engine ID is a unique alphanumeric string used to identify the SNMP engine on the switch. Its length ranges from 10 to 64 hexadecimal characters, which must be even number meanwhile. remote-engineID —— Remote Engine ID for the switch. The Engine ID is a unique alphanumeric string used to identify the SNMP engine on the remote device which receives informs from the switch. Its length ranges from 10 to 64 hexadecimal characters, which must be even number meanwhile. The snmp-server engineID will be disabled if the local and remote are both not configured. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the local engineID as 1234567890, and the remote engineID as abcdef123456: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server engineID local 1234567890 remote abcdef123456 49.8 snmp-server traps snmp Description The snmp-server traps snmp command is used to enable SNMP standard traps which include four types: linkup, linkdown, warmstart and coldstart. The command without parameter enables all SNMP standard traps. All SNMP 403 standard traps are enabled by default. To disable the sending of SNMP Syntax standard traps, please use no snmp-server traps snmp command. snmp-server traps snmp [ linkup | linkdown | warmstart | coldstart | auth-failure ] no snmp-server traps snmp [ linkup | linkdown | warmstart | coldstart | auth-failure ] Parameter linkup —— Indicates a port status changes from linkdown to linkup, and can be triggered when you connect a device to a port. linkdown —— Indicates a port status changes from linkup to linkdown, and can be triggered when you disconnect a device to a port. warmstart —— Indicates the SNMP feature on the switch is reinitialized with the physical configuration unchanged. The trap can be triggered if you disable and then enable SNMP after the SNMP is completely configured and enabled. coldstart —— Indicates an SNMP initialization caused by the reinitialization of the switch system. The trap can be triggered when you reboot the switch. auth-failure —— Triggered when a received SNMP request fails the authentication. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Enable SNMP standard linkup trap for the switch: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps snmp linkup 49.9 snmp-server traps Description The snmp-server traps command is used to enable SNMP extended traps. To disable the sending of SNMP extended traps, please use no snmp-server traps command. All SNMP extended traps are disabled by default. 404 Syntax snmp-server traps { rate-limit | cpu | flash | lldp remtableschange | lldp topologychange | loopback-detection | storm-control | spanning-tree | memory } no snmp-server traps { bandwidth-control | cpu | flash | lldp remtableschange | lldp topologychange | loopback-detection | storm-control | spanning-tree | memory } Parameter rate-limit ——Monitors whether the bandwidth has reached the limit you have set. The trap can be triggered when the Rate Limit feature is enabled and packets are sent to the port with a rate higher than what you have set. cpu ——Monitors the load status of the switch CPU. The trap can be triggered when the utilization rate of the CPU has exceeded the limit that you have set. The limit of CPU utilization rate for the switch is 80% by default. flash ——Triggered when flash is modified during operations such as backup, reset, firmware upgrade, configuration import, and so on. lldp remtableschange ——An lldp RemTablesChange notification is sent when the value of lldp StatsRemTableLastChangeTime changes. It can be utilized by an NMS host to trigger LLDP remote systems table maintenance polls. lldp topologychange ——A notification generated by the local device to sense the change in the topology that indicates a new remote device attached to a local port, or a remote device disconnected or moved from one port to another. loopback-detection ——The feature is used to detect loopbacks. And the trap is disabled by default. The system will generate the trap when a loopback is detected or cleared. storm-control ——The feature is used to monitor network storms. And the trap is disabled by default. The system will generate the trap when the rate of broadcast or multicast reaches the limit of storm control. spanning-tree ——The feature is used to monitor the spanning tree status. And the trap is disabled by default. The system will generate the trap in the following situations: a port changes from non-forwarding state to forwarding state or the other way round; a port receives a packet with TC flag or a TCN packet. 405 memory ——The feature is used to monitor the memory. And the trap is disabled by default. The system will generate the trap when the memory utilization exceeds 80%. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Enable SNMP extended bandwidth-control trap for the switch: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps bandwidth-control 49.10 snmp-server traps ddm Note: Only T1600G-28TS supports DDM traps. Description The snmp-server traps ddm command is used to enable the corresponding DDM traps. DDM function is used to monitor the status of the SFP modules inserted into the SFP ports on the switch. The command without parameter enables all SNMP DDM traps. To disable the sending of SNMP DDM traps, use Syntax no snmp-server traps ddm command. All DDM traps are disabled by default. snmp-server traps ddm [ temperature | voltage | bias_current | tx_power | rx_power ] no snmp-server traps ddm [ temperature | voltage | bias_current | tx_power | rx_power ] Parameter temperature ——Monitors the temperature of SFP modules inserted into the SFP ports on the switch. The trap can be triggered when the temperature of any SFP module has reached the warning or alarm threshold. voltage ——Monitors the voltage of SFP modules inserted into the SFP ports on the switch. The trap can be triggered when the voltage of any SFP module has reached the warning or alarm threshold. bias_current ——Monitors the bias current of SFP modules inserted into the SFP ports on the switch. The trap can be triggered when the bias current of any SFP module has reached the warning or alarm threshold. 406 tx_power ——Monitors the TX Power of SFP modules inserted into the SFP ports on the switch. The trap can be triggered when the TX Power of any SFP module has reached the warning or alarm threshold. rx_power ——Monitors the RX Power of SFP modules inserted into the SFP ports on the switch. The trap can be triggered when the RX Power of any SFP module has reached the warning or alarm threshold. User guidelines The snmp-server traps ddm command without any parameter is used to enable all the types of DDM traps. And the no snmp-server traps ddm command without any parameter is used to disable all the types of DDM traps. For more instructions about the alarm threshold or warning threshold, refer to Chapter 11 DDM Commands. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Example Enable all the SNMP DDM traps for the switch: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps ddm 49.11 snmp-server traps vlan Description The snmp-server traps vlan command is used to enable the corresponding VLAN traps. The command without parameter enables all SNMP VLAN traps. To disable this function, please use no snmp-server traps vlan command. All Syntax VLAN traps are disabled by default. snmp-server traps vlan [ create | delete ] no snmp-server traps vlan [create | delete ] Parameter create ——Triggered when certain VLANs are created successfully. delete ——Triggered when certain VLANs are deleted successfully. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode 407 Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Enable all SNMP extended VLAN-related traps for the switch: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps vlan Enable VLAN-created trap only for the switch: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps vlan create 49.12 snmp-server traps security Description The snmp-server traps security command is used to enable the corresponding security traps. To disable this feature, please use no snmp-server traps security command. All security traps are disabled by Syntax default. snmp-server traps security { dhcp-filter | ip-mac-binding | acl } no snmp-server traps security { dhcp-filter | ip-mac-binding } Parameter dhcp-filter —— Triggered when the DHCPv4 Filter feature is enabled and the switch receives DHCP packets from an illegal DHCP server. ip-mac-binding —— Triggered when the ARP Inspection feature is enabled and the switch receives an illegal ARP packet, or the IPv4 Source Guard feature is enabled and the switch receives an illegal IP packet. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the DHCP filter trap for the switch: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps security dhcp-filter 408 49.13 snmp-server traps acl Description The snmp-server traps acl command is used to enable the ACL trap. To disable this feature, please use no snmp-server traps acl command. It is disabled by default. The trap monitors matched ACL information, including the matched ACL ID, rule ID and the number of the matched packets. With both this trap and the Logging feature in ACL rule settings enabled, the switch will check the matched ACL information every five minutes and send SNMP traps if there is Syntax any updated information. snmp-server traps acl no snmp-server traps acl Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the ACL trap for the switch: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps acl 49.14 snmp-server traps ip Description The snmp-server traps ip command is used to enable IP traps. To disable this feature, please use no snmp-server traps ip command. All IP traps are Syntax disabled by default. snmp-server traps ip { change | duplicate } no snmp-server traps ip { change | duplicate } Parameter change —— Triggered when the DHCPv4 Filter feature is enabled and the switch receives DHCP packets from an illegal DHCP server. duplicate —— Triggered when the ARP Inspection feature is enabled and the switch receives an illegal ARP packet, or the IPv4 Source Guard feature is enabled and the switch receives an illegal IP packet. 409 Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the IP-Change trap for the switch: T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps ip change 49.15 snmp-server traps power Note: Only T1600G-28MPS supports this command. Description The snmp-server traps power command is used to enable PoE traps. The command without parameter enables all PoE traps. To disable this feature, please use no snmp-server traps power command. All PoE traps are Syntax disabled by default. snmp-server traps power [over-max-pwr-budget | port-pwr-change | port-pwr-deny | port-pwr-over-30w | port-pwr-overload | port-short-circuit | thermal-shutdown ] no snmp-server traps power [over-max-pwr-budget | port-pwr-change | port-pwr-deny | port-pwr-over-30w | port-pwr-overload | port-short-circuit | thermal-shutdown ] Parameter over-max-pwr-budget ——Triggered when the total power required by the connected PDs exceeds the maximum power the PoE switch can supply. port-pwr-change ——Triggered when the total power required by the connected PDs exceeds the maximum power the PoE switch can supply. port-pwr-deny ——Triggered when the switch powers off PDs on low-priority PoE ports. When the total power required by the connected PDs exceeds the system power limit, the switch will power off PDs on low-priority PoE ports to ensure stable running of the other PDs. port-pwr-over-30w ——Triggered when the power required by the connected PD exceeds 30 watts. port-pwr-overload ——Triggered when the power required by the connected PD exceeds the maximum power the port can supply. 410 port-short-circuit ——Triggered when a short circuit is detected on a port. thermal-shutdown ——Triggered when the PSE chip overheats. The switch will stop supplying power in this case. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Enable all PoE traps for the switch: T1600G-28MPS(config)# snmp-server traps power 49.16 snmp-server traps link-status Description The snmp-server traps link-status command is used to enable SNMP link status trap for the specified port. To disable the sending of SNMP link status trap, please use no snmp-server traps link-status command. By default, it is Syntax disabled. snmp-server traps link-status no snmp-server traps link-status Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Enable SNMP link status trap for port 3: T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3 T1600G-28TS(config-if)# snmp-server traps link-status 411 49.17 rmon history Description The rmon history command is used to configure the history sample entry. To return to the default configuration, please use no rmon history command. RMON (Remote Monitoring), basing on SNMP architecture, functions to monitor the network. History Group is one of the commonly used RMON Groups. After a history group is configured, the switch collects network statistics information periodically, based on which the management station Syntax can monitor network effectively. rmon history index interface gigabitEthernet port [ interval interval ] [ owner owner-name ] [ buckets number ] no rmon history index Parameter index —— The index number of the entry, ranging from 1 to 12, in the format of 1-3,5. port ——The Ethernet port number. interval —— The interval to take samplings from the port, ranging from 10 to 3600 in seconds. By default, it is 1800. owner-name —— The owner of the history sample entry, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. By default, it is “monitor”. number —— The maximum number of buckets desired for the RMON history group of statistics, ranging from 1 to 130. The default is 50 buckets. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the sample port as Gi1/0/2 and the sample interval as 100 seconds for the entry 1-3: T1600G-28TS(config)# rmon history 1-3 interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 interval 100 owner owner1 412 49.18 rmon event Description The rmon event command is used to configure the entries of SNMP-RMON Event. To return to the default configuration, please use no rmon event command. Event Group, as one of the commonly used RMON Groups, is used Syntax to define RMON events. Alarms occur when an event is detected. rmon event index [ user user-name ] [ description descript ] [ type { none | log | notify | log-notify }] [ owner owner-name ] no rmon event index Parameter index —— The index number of the event entry, ranging from 1 to 12. You can only select one entry for each command. user-name —— The name of the User to which the event belongs, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. By default, it is “public”. descript —— The description of the event, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. By default, it is empty. type —— The event type, with none, log, notify and both options. None indicates no processing, log indicates logging the event, notify indicates sending trap messages to the management station, and both indicates logging the event and sending trap messages to the management station. owner-name —— The owner of the event entry, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. By default, it is “monitor”. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the user name of entry 1, 2, 3 and 4 as user1, the description of the event as description1, the type of event as log and the owner of the event as owner1: T1600G-28TS(config)# rmon event 1-4 user user1 description description1 type log owner owner1 413 49.19 rmon alarm Description The rmon alarm command is used to configure SNMP-RMON Alarm Management. To return to the default configuration, please use no rmon alarm command. Alarm Group is one of the commonly used RMON Groups. RMON alarm management allows monitoring the specific alarm variables. When the value of a monitored variable exceeds the threshold, an alarm event Syntax is generated, which triggers the switch to act in the set way. rmon alarm index { stats-index sindex } [ alarm-variable { revbyte | revpkt | bpkt | mpkt | crc-lign | undersize | oversize | jabber | collision | 64 | 65-127 | 128-511 | 512-1023 | 1024-10240 }] [ s-type { absolute | delta} ] [ rising-threshold r-hold ] [ rising-event-index r-event] [ falling-threshold f-hold] [ falling-event-index f-event] [ a-type {rise | fall | all} ] [ owner owner-name ] [ interval interval] no rmon alarm index Parameter index —— The index number of the Alarm Management entry, ranging from 1 to 12, in the format of 1-3,5. sindex —— Specify the statistics index. alarm-variable —— The alarm variable. By default, the option is revbyte. s-type —— Sample Type, which is the sampling method for the selected variable and comparing the value against the thresholds. There are two options, absolute and delta. Absolute indicates comparing the values directly with the thresholds at the end of the sampling interval. Delta indicates subtracting the last sampled value from the current value, and then comparing the difference in the values with the threshold. By default, the Sample Type is absolute. r-hold —— The rising counter value that triggers the Rising Threshold alarm, ranging from 1 to 2147483647. By default, it is 100. r-event —— Rise Event, which is the index of the corresponding event which will be triggered if the sampled value is larger than the Rising Threshold. It ranges from 1 to 12. f-hold —— The falling counter value that triggers the Falling Threshold alarm, ranging from 1 to 2147483647. By default, it is 100. 414 f-event —— Fall Event, which is the index of the corresponding event which will be triggered if the sampled value is lower than the Falling Threshold. It ranges from 1 to 12. a-type —— Alarm Type, with rise, fall and all options. Rise indicates that the alarm event will be triggered when the sampled value exceeds the Rising Threshold, fall indicates that the alarm event will be triggered when the sampled value is under the Falling Threshold, and all indicates that the alarm event will be triggered either the sampled value exceeds the Rising Threshold or is under the Falling Threshold. By default, the Alarm Type is all. owner-name —— The owner of the entry, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. By default, it is monitor. interval —— The alarm interval time, ranging from 10 to 3600 in seconds. By default, it is 1800. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Configure rmon alarm entries 1-3 binding with statistics entry 2, the owners as owner1 and the alarm intervals as 100 seconds: T1600G-28TS(config)#rmon alarm 1-3 stats-index 2 owner owner1 interval 100 49.20 rmon statistics Description The rmon statistics command is used to configure the entries of SNMP-RMON statistics. To delete the corresponding entry, please use no Syntax rmon statistics command. The maximum supported entries are 1000. rmon statistics index interface gigabitEthernet port [ owner owner-name] [ status { underCreation | valid }] no rmon statistics index Parameter index —— The index number of the statistics entry, ranging from 1 to 65535, in the format of 1-3,5. 415 port —— The statistics port number, in the format of 1/0/1. owner-name —— The creator of the event entry, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. By default, it is “monitor”. status —— The status of the statistics entry, either “underCreation” or “valid”. “underCreation” means this entry won’t take effect until it is modified to “valid”; “valid” means this entry takes effect immediately after it is created. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the statistics entries 1-3 with the statistics port as 1/0/1, owner as owner1 and status as valid: T1600G-28TS(config)#rmon statistics 1-3 interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 owner owner1 status valid 49.21 show snmp-server Description The show snmp-server command is used to display SNMP configuration Syntax globally. show snmp-server Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display SNMP configuration globally: T1600G-28TS# show snmp-server 49.22 show snmp-server view Description The show snmp-server view command is used to display the View table. 416 Syntax show snmp-server view Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the View table: T1600G-28TS# show snmp-server view 49.23 show snmp-server group Description Syntax The show snmp-server group command is used to display the Group table. show snmp-server group Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the Group table: T1600G-28TS# show snmp-server group 49.24 show snmp-server user Description Syntax The show snmp-server user command is used to display the User table. show snmp-server user Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. 417 Example Display the User table: T1600G-28TS# show snmp-server user 49.25 show snmp-server community Description The show snmp-server community command is used to display the Syntax Community table. show snmp-server community Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the Community table: T1600G-28TS# show snmp-server community 49.26 show snmp-server host Description Syntax The show snmp-server host command is used to display the Host table. show snmp-server host Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the Host table: T1600G-28TS# show snmp-server host 418 49.27 show snmp-server engineID Description The show snmp-server engineID command is used to display the engineID Syntax of the SNMP. show snmp-server engineID Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the engineID: T1600G-28TS# show snmp-server engineID 49.28 show rmon history Description The show rmon history command is used to display the configuration of the Syntax history sample entry. show rmon history [ index ] Parameter index —— The index number of the entry selected to display the configuration, ranging from 1 to 12, in the format of 1-3, 5. You can select more than one entry for each command. By default, the configuration of all history sample entries is displayed. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the configuration of all history sample entries: T1600G-28TS# show rmon history 419 49.29 show rmon event Description The show rmon event command is used to display the configuration of Syntax SNMP-RMON Event. show rmon event [ index ] Parameter index —— The index number of the entry selected to display the configuration, ranging from 1 to 12, in the format of 1-3, 5. You can select more than one entry for each command. By default, the configuration of all SNMP-RMON enabled entries is displayed. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the Event configuration of entry1-4: T1600G-28TS# show rmon event 1-4 49.30 show rmon alarm Description The show rmon alarm command is used to display the configuration of the Syntax Alarm Management entry. show rmon alarm [ index ] Parameter index —— The index number of the entry selected to display the configuration, ranging from 1 to 12, in the format of 1-3, 5. You can select more than one entry for each command. By default, the configuration of all Alarm Management entries is displayed. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode 420 Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the configuration of the Alarm Management entry 1-2: T1600G-28TS# show rmon alarm 1-2 49.31 show rmon statistics Description The show rmon statistics command is used to display the configuration of Syntax the specified statistics entry. show rmon statistics [ index ] Parameter index —— The index number of the statistics entry selected to display the configuration, ranging from 1 to 65535. By default, the configuration of all statistics entries is displayed. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin level users have access to these commands. Example Display the configuration of the statistics entry 1: T1600G-28TS#show rmon statistics 1 421 Chapter 50 PoE Commands Note: Only T1600G-28MPS supports PoE function. PoE (Power over Ethernet) technology describes a system to transmit electrical power along with data to remote devices over standard twisted-pair cable in an Ethernet network. It is especially useful for supplying power to IP telephones, wireless LAN access points, cameras and so on. 50.1 power inline consumption (global) Description The power inline consumption command is used to configure the max Syntax power the PoE switch can supply globally. power inline consumption power-limit Parameter power-limit ——The max power the PoE switch can supply, ranging from 1 to 384w. By default, the value is 384. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Configure the max power the PoE switch can supply as 160w: T1600G-28PS(config)# power inline consumption 160 50.2 power profile Description The power profile command is used to create a PoE profile for the switch. To delete the configured PoE profile configuration, please use no power profile command. PoE Profile is a short cut for the configuration of the PoE port. In a PoE profile, the PoE status, PoE priority and power limit are configured. You can specify a PoE profile for each PoE port individually. 422 Syntax power profile name [supply {enable | disable} [priority {low | middle | high} [consumption { power-limit | auto | class1 | class2 | class3 | class4 } ] ] ] no power profile name Parameter name —— The PoE profile name, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. If the name being assigned contains spaces then put it inside double quotes. supply —— The PoE status of the port in the profile. By default, the PoE status is “enable”. priority —— The PoE priority of the port in the profile. The priority levels include “high”, “middle” and “low” in descending order. When the supply power exceeds the system power limit, the PD linked to the port with lower priority will be disconnected. By default, the PoE priority is “low”. consumption —— The max power the port in the profile can supply, with five options: “power-limit”, “auto”, ”class1”, “class2”, “class3” and “class4”. “Power-limit” indicates you can manually enter a value ranging from 1 to 300. The value is in the unit of 0.1 watt. For instance, if you want to configure the max power as 5w, you should enter 50. “Auto” indicates the value is assigned automatically by the PoE switch. “Class1” represents 4w. “Class2” represents 7w. “Class3” represents 15.4w. “Class4” represents 30w. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Create a PoE profile named “IP Camera” whose PoE status is “enable”, PoE priority is “low” and the power limit is “5w”: T1600G-28PS(config)# power profile “IP Camera” supply enable priority low consumption 50 50.3 power inline consumption (interface) Description The power inline consumption command is used to configure the power limit the corresponding port can supply. 423 Syntax power inline consumption { power-limit | auto | class1 | class2 | class3 | class4 } Parameter power-limit —— The max power the port in the profile can supply, with five options: “power-limit”, “auto”, ”class1”, “class2”, “class3” and “class4”. “Power-limit” indicates you can manually enter a value ranging from 1 to 300. The value is in the unit of 0.1 watt. For instance, if you want to configure the max power as 5w, you should enter 50. “Auto” indicates the value is assigned automatically by the PoE switch. “Class1” represents 4w. “Class2” represents 7w. “Class3” represents 15.4w. “Class4” represents 30w. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement None. Example Configure the power limit as “5w” for port 2: T1600G-28PS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28PS(config-if)# power inline consumption 50 50.4 power inline priority Description The power inline priority command is used to configure the PoE priority for Syntax the corresponding port power inline priority { low | middle | high } Parameter priority —— The PoE priority of the port. The priority levels include “high”, “middle” and “low” in descending order. When the supply power exceeds the system power limit, the PD linked to the port with lower priority will be disconnected. By default, the priority level is “low”. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range 424 gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement None. Example Configure the PoE priority as “low” for port 2: T1600G-52PS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-52PS(config-if)# power inline priority low 50.5 power inline supply Description The power inline supply command is used to configure the PoE status of the Syntax corresponding port. power inline supply { enable | disable } Parameter enable | disable —— The PoE status of the port. By default, the PoE status is “enable”. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement None. Example Enable the PoE feature for port 2: T1600G-28PS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28PS(config-if)# power inline supply enable 50.6 power inline profile Description The power inline profile command is used to bind a PoE profile to the corresponding port. To cancel the bind relation, please use no power inline profile command. 425 Syntax power inline profile name no power inline profile Parameter name —— The name of the PoE profile to be bound to the port. If the name being assigned contains spaces then put it inside double quotes. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement None. Example Bind the PoE profile named “IP Camera” to port 2: T1600G-28PS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28PS(config-if)# power inline profile “IP Camera” 50.7 power inline time-range Description The power inline time-range command is used to bind a PoE time-range to the corresponding port. To cancel the bind relation, please use no power Syntax inline time-range command. power inline time-range name no power inline time-range Parameter name —— The name of the PoE time-range to be bound to the port. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Bind the PoE time-range named “tRange2" to port 2: 426 T1600G-28PS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2 T1600G-28PS(config-if)# power inline time-range tRange2 50.8 show power inline Description The show power inline command is used to display the global PoE Syntax information of the system. show power inline Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the PoE information of the system: T1600G-28PS# show power inline 50.9 show power inline configuration interface Description The show power inline configuration interface command is used to display Syntax the PoE configuration of the certain port. show power inline configuration interface [ gigabitEthernet port ] Parameter port —— The Ethernet port number. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the PoE configuration of all ports: 427 T1600G-28PS# show power inline configuration interface 50.10 show power inline information interface Description The show power inline information command is used to display the PoE Syntax information of the certain port. show power inline information interface [ gigabitEthernet port ] Parameter port —— The Ethernet port number. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the PoE information of all ports: T1600G-28PS# show power inline information interface 50.11 show power profile Description Syntax The show power profile command is used to display the defined PoE profile. show power profile Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the defined PoE profile: T1600G-28PS# show power profile 428 Chapter 51 ARP Inspection Commands ARP (Address Resolution Protocol) Detect function is to protect the switch from the ARP cheating, such as the Network Gateway Spoofing and Man-In-The-Middle Attack, etc. 51.1 ip arp inspection Description The ip arp inspection command is used to enable the ARP Detection function globally. To disable the ARP Detection function, please use no ip arp detection command. Syntax ip arp inspection no ip arp inspection Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the ARP Detection function globally: T1600G-28TS(config)#ip arp inspection 51.2 ip arp inspection validate Description The ip arp inspection validate command is used to enable the switch to check whether the reveided ARP packet is illegal. To disable,the feature please use no ip arp detection validate command. Syntax ip arp inspection validate { src-mac | dst-mac | ip } no ip arp inspection validate { src-mac | dst-mac | ip } 429 Syntax src-mac —— Enable the switch to check whether the source MAC address and the sender MAC address are the same when receiving an ARP packet. If not, the ARP packet will be discarded. dst-mac —— Enable the switch to check whether the sender IP address of all ARP packets and the target IP address of ARP reply packets are legal. The illegal packets will be discarded. ip —— Enable or disable the switch to check whether the sender IP address of all ARP packets and the target IP address of ARP reply packets are legal. The illegal packets will be discarded. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the switch to check whether the source MAC address and the sender MAC address are the same when receiving an ARP packet T1600G-28TS(config)#ip arp inspection validate src-mac 51.3 ip arp inspection vlan Description The ip arp inspection vlan command is used to enable the ARP Detection function on VLANs. To disable the ARP Detection function on VLANs, please use no ip arp detection vlan command. Syntax ip arp inspection vlan vlan-list no ip arp inspection vlan vlan-list Syntax vlan-list —— Enter the VLAN ID. The format is 1,5-9. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode 430 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the ARP Detection function on VLAN 2: T1600G-28TS(config)#ip arp inspection vlan 2 51.4 ip arp inspection vlan logging Description The ip arp inspection vlan logging command is used to enable the Log function on the specific VLAN. To disable the Log function on the VLAN, please use no ip arp detection vlan logging command. Syntax ip arp inspection vlan vlan-list logging no ip arp inspection vlan vlan-list logging Syntax vlan-list —— Enter the VLAN ID. The format is 1,5-9. logging —— Enable the Log feature to make the switch generate a log when an ARP packet is discarded. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the log feature on VLAN 2: T1600G-28TS(config)#ip arp inspection vlan 2 logging 431 51.5 ip arp inspection trust Description The ip arp inspection trust command is used to configure the port for which the ARP Detect function is unnecessary as the Trusted Port. To clear the Trusted Port list, please use no ip arp detection trust command .The specific ports, such as up-linked port and routing port and LAG port, should be set as Trusted Port. To ensure the normal communication of the switch, please configure the ARP Trusted Port before enabling the ARP Detect function. Syntax ip arp inspection trust no ip arp inspection trust Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the Gigabit Ethernet ports 1/0/2-5 as the Trusted Port: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-5 T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ip arp inspection trust 51.6 ip arp inspection limit-rate Description The ip arp inspection limit-rate command is used to configure the ARP speed of a specified port. To restore to the default speed, please use no ip arp inspection limit-rate command. Syntax ip arp inspection limit-rate value no ip arp inspection limit-rate 432 Parameter value ——The value to specify the maximum amount of the received ARP packets per second, ranging from 1 to 300 in pps(packet/second). By default, the value is 100. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the maximum amount of the received ARP packets per second as 50 pps for Gigabit Ethernet port 5: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip arp inspection limit-rate 50 51.7 ip arp inspection burst-interval Description The ip arp inspection burst-interval command is used to configure the burst interval of a specified port. To restore to the default speed, please use no ip arp inspection burst-interval command. Syntax ip arp inspection burst-interval value no ip arp inspection burst-interval Parameter value —— Specify a time range. If the speed of received ARP packets in this time range reaches the limit for this time range, the port will be shut down. The valid values are from 1 to 15 seconds, and the default value is 1 second. Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) 433 Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Configure the burst interval as 2 seconds for Gigabit Ethernet port 5: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip arp inspection burst-interval 2 51.8 ip arp inspection recover Description The ip arp inspection recover command is used to restore a port to the ARP transmit status from the ARP filter status. Syntax ip arp inspection recover Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet) Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Restore Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/5 to the ARP transmit status: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip arp inspection recover 51.9 show ip arp inspection Description The show ip arp inspection command is used to display the ARP detection global configuration including the enable/disable status and the Trusted Port list. 434 Syntax show ip arp inspection Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the ARP detection configuration globally: T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip arp inspection 51.10 show ip arp inspection interface Description The show ip arp inspection interface command is used to display the interface configuration of ARP detection. Syntax show ip arp inspection interface [ gigabitEthernet port ] Parameter port ——The Ethernet port number. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configuration of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip arp inspection interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 Display the configuration of all Ethernet ports: T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip arp inspection interface 435 51.11 show ip arp inspection vlan Description The show ip arp inspection vlan command is used to display the VLAN configuration of ARP detection. Syntax show ip arp inspection vlan Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the ARP Inspection configuration of VLAN: T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip arp inspection vlan 51.12 show ip arp inspection statistics Description The show ip arp inspection statistics command is used to display the number of the illegal ARP packets received. Syntax show ip arp inspection statistics Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the number of the illegal ARP packets received: T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip arp inspection statistics 436 51.13 clear ip arp inspection statistics Description The clear ip arp inspection statistics command is used to clear the statistic of the illegal ARP packets received. Syntax clear ip arp inspection statistics Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these commands. Example Clear the statistic of the illegal ARP packets received: T1600G-28TS(config)#clear ip arp inspection statistics 437 Chapter 52 ND Detection Commands The ND Detection feature allows the switch to detect the ND packets based on the binding entries in the IPv6-MAC Binding Table and filter out the illegal ND packets. Before configuring ND Detection, complete IPv6-MAC Binding configuration. For details, refer to IPv6-MAC Binding Configurations. 52.1 ipv6 nd detection Description The ipv6 nd detection command is used to enable the ND Detection function globally. To disable the ND Detection function, please use no ipv6 nd detection command. Syntax ipv6 nd detection no ipv6 nd detection Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Example Enable the ND Detection function globally: T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 nd detection 52.2 ipv6 nd detection vlan Description The ipv6 nd detection vlan command is used to enable ND Detection function on a specified VLAN. To disable ND Detection function on this VLAN, please use no ipv6 nd detection vlan command. Syntax ipv6 nd detection vlan vlan-range no ipv6 nd detection vlan vlan-range 438 Parameter vlan-range ——Enter the vlan range in the format of 1-3, 5. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Example Enable the ND Detection function on VLAN 1,4,6-7: T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 nd detection vlan 1,4,6-7 52.3 ipv6 nd detection vlan logging Description The ipv6 nd detection vlan logging command is used to enable Log function on a specified VLAN. To disable Log function on this VLAN, please use no ipv6 nd detection vlan logging command. Syntax ipv6 nd detection vlan vlan-range logging no ipv6 nd detection vlan vlan-range logging Parameter vlan-range ——Enter the vlan range in the format of 1-3, 5. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Example Enable the Log function on VLAN 1,4,6-7: T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 nd detection vlan 1,4,6-7 logging 52.4 ipv6 nd detection trust Description The ipv6 nd detection trust command is used to configure the port for which the ND Detection function is unnecessary as the Trusted Port. To clear the Trusted Port list, please use no ipv6 nd detection trust command .The specific port, such as up-linked port, routing port and LAG port, should be set 439 as Trusted Port. To ensure the normal communication of the switch, please configure the ND Detection Trusted Port before enabling the ND Detection function. Syntax Ipv6 nd detection trust no ipv6 nd detection trust Command Mode Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range gigabitEthernet/ interface port-channel / interface range port-channel) Example Configure the Gigabit Ethernet ports 1/0/2-5 as the Trusted Port: T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-5 T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ipv6 nd detection trust 52.5 show ipv6 nd detection Description The show ipv6 nd detection command is used to display the ND detection global configuration including the enable/disable status. Syntax show ipv6 nd detection Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Example Display the ND Detection configuration globally: T1600G-28TS(config)#show ipv6 nd detection 52.6 show ipv6 nd detection interface Description The show ipv6 nd detection interface command is used to display the interface configuration of ND Detection. 440 Syntax show ipv6 nd detection interface[ fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] Parameter port ——The Ethernet port number. port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Example Display the configuration of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1: T1600G-28TS(config)#show ipv6 nd detection interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1 Display the configuration of all Ethernet ports: T1600G-28TS(config)#show ipv6 nd detection interface 52.7 show ipv6 nd detection vlan Description The show ipv6 nd detection vlan command is used to display the VLAN configuration of ND Detection. Syntax show ipv6 nd detection vlan Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Example Display the ipv6 ND Detection configuration of VLAN. T1600G-28TS(config)#show ipv6 nd detection vlan 441 Chapter 53 System Log Commands The log information will record the settings and operation of the switch respectively for you to monitor operation status and diagnose malfunction. 53.1 logging buffer Description The logging buffer command is used to store the system log messages to an internal buffer. To disable the log buffer function, please use the no logging buffer command. Local Log is the system log information saved in the switch. It has two output channels, that is, it can be saved to two different positions, log buffer and log flash memory. The log buffer indicates the RAM for saving system log and the information in the log buffer can be got by show logging buffer command. It will be lost when the switch is restarted. Syntax logging buffer no logging buffer Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the system log buffer: T1600G-28TS(config)#logging buffer 53.2 logging buffer level Description The logging buffer level command is used to configure the severity level and the status of the configuration input to the log buffer. To return to the default configuration, please use no logging buffer level command. 442 Syntax logging buffer level level no logging buffer level Parameter level —— Severity level of the log information output to each channel. There are 8 severity levels marked with values 0-7. The smaller value has the higher priority. Only the log with the same or smaller severity level value will be output. By default, it is 6 indicating that the log information with level 0-6 will be saved in the log buffer. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Set the severity level as 5: T1600G-28TS(config)#logging buffer level 5 53.3 logging file flash Description The logging file flash command is used to store the log messages in a file in the flash on the switch. To disable the log file flash function, please use no logging file flash command. This function is disabled by default. The log file flash indicates the flash sector for saving system log. The information in the log file of the flash will not be lost after the switch is restarted and can be got by the show logging flash command. Syntax logging file flash no logging file flash Command Mode Global Configuration Mode 443 Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Enable the log file flash function: T1600G-28TS(config)#logging file flash 53.4 logging file flash frequency Description The logging file flash frequency command is used to specify the frequency to synchronize the system log file in the log buffer to the flash. To resume the default synchronizing frequency, please use the no logging file flash frequency command. Syntax logging file flash frequency { periodic periodic | immediate } no logging file flash frequency Parameter periodic —— The frequency to synchronize the system log file in the log buffer to the flash, ranging from 1 to 48 hours. By default, the synchronization process takes place every 24 hours. immediate —— The system log file in the buffer will be synchronized to the flash immediately. This option will reduce the life of the flash and is not recommended. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Specify the log file synchronization frequency as 10 hours: T1600G-28TS(config)#logging file flash frequency periodic10 444 53.5 logging file flash level Description The logging file flash level command is used to specify the system log message severity level. Messages will a severity level equal to or higher than this value will be stored to the flash. To restore to the default level, please use no logging file flash level command. Syntax logging file flash level level no logging file flash level Parameter level —— Severity level of the log message. There are 8 severity levels marked with values 0-7. The smaller value has the higher priority. Only the log with the same or smaller severity level value will be saved to the flash. By default, it is 3 indicating that the log message marked with 0~3 will be saved in the log flash. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Save the log messages with their severities equal or higher than 7 to the flash : T1600G-28TS(config)#logging file flash level 7 53.6 logging host index Description The logging host index command is used to configure the Log Host. To clear the configuration of the specified Log Host, please use no logging host index command. Log Host is to receive the system log from other devices. You can remotely monitor the settings and operation status of other devices through the log host. 445 Syntax logging host index idx host-ip level no logging host index idx Parameter idx —— The index of the log host. The switch supports 4 log hosts at most. host-ip —— The IP for the log host. level —— The severity level of the log information sent to each log host. There are 8 severity levels marked with values 0-7. The smaller value has the higher priority. Only the log with the same or smaller severity level value will be sent to the corresponding log host. By default, it is 6 indicating that the log information marked with 0~6 will be sent to the log host. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Enable log host 2 and set its IP address as 192.168.0.148, the level 5: T1600G-28TS(config)# logging host index 2 192.168.0.148 5 53.7 logging console Description The logging console command is used to send the system logs to the console port. To disable logging to the console, please use no logging console command. This function is enabled by default. Syntax logging console no logging console Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. 446 Example Enable logging to the console port: T1600G-28TS(config)# logging console 53.8 logging console level Description The logging console level command is used to limit messages logged to the console port. System logs no higher than the set threshold level will be displayed on the console port. To restore the threshold level to default value, please use no logging console level command. Syntax logging console level level no logging monitor level Parameter level —— Severity level of the log information output to the console port. There are 8 severity levels marked with values 0-7. The smaller value has the higher priority. Only the log with the same or smaller severity level value will be output to the terminal devices. By default, it is 5 indicating that all the log information between level 0-5 will be output to the terminal devices. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Output the log information with severity levels between 0-7 to the console port: T1600G-28TS(config)# logging console level 7 447 53.9 logging monitor Description The logging monitor command is used to display the system logs on the terminal devices. To disable logging to the terminal, please use no logging monitor command. This function is enabled by default. Syntax logging monitor no logging monitor Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Disable logging to the terminal devices: T1600G-28TS(config)# no logging monitor 53.10 logging monitor level Description The logging monitor level command is used to limit messages logged to the terminal devices. System logs no higher than the set threshold level will be displayed on the terminal devices. To restore the threshold level to default value, please use no logging monitor level command. Syntax logging monitor level level no logging monitor level Parameter level —— Severity level of the log information output to the terminal devices. There are 8 severity levels marked with values 0-7. The smaller value has the higher priority. Only the log with the same or smaller severity level value will 448 be output to the terminal devices. By default, it is 5 indicating that all the log information between level 0-5 will be output to the terminal devices. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Output the log information with severity levels between 0-7 to the terminal devices: T1600G-28TS(config)# logging monitor level 7 53.11 clear logging Description The clear logging command is used to clear the information in the log buffer and log file. Syntax clear logging [ buffer | flash ] Parameter buffer | flash —The output channels: buffer and flash. Clear the information of the two channels, by default. Command Mode Global Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands. Example Clear the information in the log file: T1600G-28TS(config)# clear logging buffer 449 53.12 show logging local-config Description The show logging local-config command is used to display the configuration of the Local Log output to the console, the terminal, the log buffer and the log file. Syntax show logging local-config Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the configuration of the Local Log: T1600G-28TS(config)# show logging local-config 53.13 show logging loghost Description The show logging loghost command is used to display the configuration of the log host. Syntax show logging loghost [ index ] Parameter index ——The index of the log host whose configuration will be displayed, ranging from 1 to 4. Display the configuration of all the log hosts by default. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. 450 Example Display the configuration of the log host 2: T1600G-28TS(config)# show logging loghost 2 53.14 show logging buffer Description The show logging buffer command is used to display the log information in the log buffer according to the severity level. Syntax show logging buffer [ level level ] Parameter level —— Severity level. There are 8 severity levels marked with values 0-7. The information of levels with priority not lower than the select level will display. Display all the log information in the log buffer by default. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the log information from level 0 to level 5 in the log buffer: T1600G-28TS(config)# show logging buffer level 5 53.15 show logging flash Description The show logging flash command is used to display the log information in the log file according to the severity level. Syntax show logging flash [ level level ] 451 Parameter level —— Severity level. There are 8 severity levels marked with values 0-7. The information of levels with priority not lower than the select level will display. Display all the log information in the log file by default. Command Mode Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode Privilege Requirement None. Example Display the log information with the level marked 0~3 in the log file: T1600G-28TS(config)# show logging flash level 3 452
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf PDF Version : 1.5 Linearized : No Create Date : 2017:12:05 16:16:02+08:00 Modify Date : 2017:12:05 16:19:06+08:00 Subject : Tagged PDF : Yes XMP Toolkit : Adobe XMP Core 5.4-c005 78.147326, 2012/08/23-13:03:03 Metadata Date : 2017:12:05 16:19:06+08:00 Creator Tool : Acrobat PDFMaker 11 Word 版 Document ID : uuid:6317d31a-a7f6-4f75-80bb-719a918451e4 Instance ID : uuid:68f194b3-21eb-4a40-b690-619766135f42 Format : application/pdf Title : Description : Creator : Producer : Adobe PDF Library 11.0 Page Layout : OneColumn Page Mode : UseOutlines Page Count : 473 Warning : [Minor] Ignored duplicate Info dictionaryEXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools